RFC2801

From RFC-Wiki

Network Working Group D. Burdett Request for Comments: 2801 Commerce One Category: Informational April 2000

             Internet Open Trading Protocol - IOTP
                          Version 1.0

Status of this Memo

This memo provides information for the Internet community. It does not specify an Internet standard of any kind. Distribution of this memo is unlimited.

Copyright Notice

Copyright (C) The Internet Society (2000). All Rights Reserved.

Abstract

The Internet Open Trading Protocol (IOTP) provides an interoperable framework for Internet commerce. It is payment system independent and encapsulates payment systems such as SET, Secure Channel Credit/Debit, Mondex, CyberCoin, GeldKarte, etc. IOTP is able to handle cases where such merchant roles as the shopping site, the Payment Handler, the Delivery Handler of goods or services, and the provider of customer support are performed by different parties or by one party.

     6.1.3  Using signatures to Prove Actions Complete
     9.1.13 Combining Authentication Transactions with other
     9.2.1  Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry IOTP Transaction 235
     11.2.2 Credit Card Brand List Including Promotional Brands..253

Table of Figures

Figure 1 IOTP Trading Roles 16 Figure 2 Offer Exchange 19 Figure 3 Payment Exchange 22 Figure 4 Delivery Exchange 25 Figure 5 Authentication Exchange 27 Figure 6 IOTP Message Structure 33 Figure 7 An IOTP Transaction 34 Figure 8 Example use of ID attributes 46 Figure 9 Element References 48 Figure 10 Signature Digests 79 Figure 11 Example use of Signatures for Baseline Purchase 81 Figure 12 Checking a Payment Handler can carry out a Payment 87 Figure 13 Checking a Delivery Handler can carry out a Delivery 90 Figure 14 Trading Components 94 Figure 15 Brand List Element Relationships 113 Figure 16 Trading Blocks 164 Figure 17 Payment and Authentication Message Flow Combinations 187 Figure 18 Authentication Document Exchange 190 Figure 19 Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange 196 Figure 20 Brand Independent Offer Exchange 198 Figure 21 Payment Document Exchange 204 Figure 22 Delivery Document Exchange 210 Figure 23 Payment and Delivery Document Exchange 214 Figure 24 Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction 217 Figure 25 Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction 219 Figure 26 Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction 221 Figure 27 Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction 223 Figure 28 Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction 225 Figure 29 Baseline Value Exchange IOTP Transaction 228 Figure 30 Baseline Value Exchange Signatures 230 Figure 31 Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges 231 Figure 32 Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry 238 Figure 33 Baseline Ping Messages 242

Contents

Background

The Internet Open Trading Protocol (IOTP) provides an interoperable framework for Internet commerce. It is payment system independent and encapsulates payment systems such as SET, Mondex, CyberCash, DigiCash, GeldKarte, etc. IOTP is able to handle cases where such merchant roles as the shopping site, the Payment Handler, the Delivery Handler of goods or services, and the provider of customer support are performed by different parties or by one party.

The developers of IOTP seek to provide a virtual capability that safely replicates the real world, the paper based, traditional, understood, accepted methods of trading, buying, selling, value exchanging that has existed for many hundreds of years. The negotiation of who will be the parties to the trade, how it will be conducted, the presentment of an offer, the method of payment, the provision of a payment receipt, the delivery of goods and the receipt of goods. These are events that are taken for granted in the course of real world trade. IOTP has been produced to provide the same for the virtual world, and to prepare and provide for the introduction of new models of trading made possible by the expanding presence of the virtual world.

The other fundamental ideal of the IOTP effort is to produce a definition of these trading events in such a way that no matter where produced, two unfamiliar parties using electronic commerce capabilities to buy and sell that conform to the IOTP specifications will be able to complete the business safely and successfully.

In summary, IOTP supports:

o Familiar trading models

o New trading models

o Global interoperability

The remainder of this section provides background to why IOTP was developed. The specification itself starts in the next chapter.

Commerce on the Internet, a Different Model

The growth of the Internet and the advent of electronic commerce are bringing about enormous changes around the world in society, politics and government, and in business. The ways in which trading partners communicate, conduct commerce, are governed have been enriched and changed forever.

One of the very fundamental changes about which IOTP is concerned is taking place in the way consumers and merchants trade. Characteristics of trading that have changed markedly include:

o Presence: Face-to-face transactions become the exception, not the

  rule.  Already with the rise of mail order and telephone order
  placement this change has been felt in western commerce.
  Electronic commerce over the Internet will further expand the
  scope and volume of transactions conducted without ever seeing the
  people who are a part of the enterprise with whom one does
  business.

o Authentication: An important part of personal presence is the

  ability of the parties to use familiar objects and dialogue to
  confirm they are who they claim to be. The seller displays one or
  several well known financial logos that declaim his ability to
  accept widely used credit and debit instruments in the payment
  part of a purchase. The buyer brings government or financial
  institution identification that assures the seller she will be
  paid. People use intangibles such as personal appearance and
  conduct, location of the store, apparent quality and familiarity
  with brands of merchandise, and a good clear look in the eye to
  reinforce formal means of authentication.

o Payment Instruments: Despite the enormous size of bank card

  financial payments associations and their members, most of the
  world's trade still takes place using the coin of the realm or
  barter. The present infrastructure of the payments business cannot
  economically support low value transactions and could not survive
  under the consequent volumes of transactions if it did accept low
  value transactions.

o Transaction Values: New meaning for low value transactions arises

  in the Internet where sellers may wish to offer for example, pages
  of information for fractions of currency that do not exist in the
  real world.

o Delivery: New modes of delivery must be accommodated such as

  direct electronic delivery. The means by which receipt is
  confirmed and the execution of payment change dramatically where
  the goods or services have extremely low delivery cost but may in
  fact have very high value.  Or, maybe the value is not high, but
  once delivery occurs the value is irretrievably delivered so
  payment must be final and non-refundable but delivery nonetheless
  must still be confirmed before payment.  Incremental delivery such
  as listening or viewing time or playing time are other models that
  operate somewhat differently in the virtual world.

Benefits of IOTP

ELECTRONIC COMMERCE SOFTWARE VENDORS

Electronic Commerce Software Vendors will be able to develop e- commerce products which are more attractive as they will inter- operate with any other vendors' software. However, since IOTP focuses on how these solutions communicate, there is still plenty of opportunity for product differentiation.

PAYMENT BRANDS

IOTP provides a standard framework for encapsulating payment protocols. This means that it is easier for payment products to be incorporated into IOTP solutions. As a result the payment brands will be more widely distributed and available on a wider variety of platforms.

MERCHANTS

There are several benefits for Merchants:

o they will be able to offer a wider variety of payment brands,

o they can be more certain that the customer will have the software

  needed to complete the purchase

o through receiving payment and delivery receipts from their

  customers, they will be able to provide customer care knowing that
  they are dealing with the individual or organisation with which
  they originally traded

o new merchants will be able to enter this new (Internet) market-

  place with new products and services, using the new trading
  opportunities which IOTP presents

BANKS AND FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS

There are also several benefits for Banks and Financial Institutions:

o they will be able to provide IOTP support for merchants

o they will find new opportunities for IOTP related services:

  -  providing customer care for merchants
  -  fees from processing new payments and deposits

o they have an opportunity to build relationships with new types of

  merchants

CUSTOMERS

For Customers there are several benefits:

o they will have a larger selection of merchants with whom they can

  trade

o there is a more consistent interface when making the purchase

o there are ways in which they can get their problems fixed through

  the merchant (rather than the bank!)

o there is a record of their transaction which can be used, for

  example, to feed into accounting systems or, potentially, to
  present to the tax authorities

Baseline IOTP

This specification is Baseline IOTP. It is a Baseline in that it contains ways of doing trades on the Internet which are the most common, for example purchases and refunds.

The group that has worked on the IOTP see an extended version being developed over time but feel a need to focus on a limited function but completely usable specification in order that implementers can develop solutions that work now.

During this period it is anticipated that there will be no changes to the scope of this specification with the only changes made being limited to corrections where problems are found. Software solutions have been developed based on earlier versions of this specification (for example version 0.9 published in early 1998 and earlier revisions of version 1.0 published during 1999) which prove that the IOTP works.

Objectives of Document

The objectives of this document are to provide a specification of version 1.0 of the Internet Open Trading Protocols which can be used to design and implement systems which support electronic trading on the Internet using the Internet Open Trading Protocols.

The purpose of the document is:

o to allow potential developers of products based on the protocol to

  develop software/hardware solutions which use the protocol

o to allow the financial services industry to understand a

  developing electronic commerce trading protocol that encapsulates
  (without modification) any of the current or developing payment
  schemes now being used or considered by their merchant customer
  base

Scope of Document

The protocol describes the content, format and sequences of messages that pass among the participants in an electronic trade - consumers, merchants and banks or other financial institutions, and customer care providers. These are required to support the electronic commerce transactions outlined in the objectives above.

The protocol is designed to be applicable to any electronic payment scheme since it targets the complete purchase process where the movement of electronic value from the payer to the payee is only one, but important, step of many that may be involved to complete the trade.

Payment Scheme which IOTP could support include MasterCard Credit, Visa Credit, Mondex Cash, Visa Cash, GeldKarte, eCash, CyberCoin, Millicent, Proton, etc.

Each payment scheme contains some message flows which are specific to that scheme. These scheme-specific parts of the protocol are contained in a set of payment scheme supplements to this specification.

The document does not prescribe the software and processes that will need to be implemented by each participant. It does describe the framework necessary for trading to take place.

This document also does not address any legal or regulatory issues surrounding the implementation of the protocol or the information systems which use them.

Document Structure

The document consists of the following sections:

o Section 1 - Background: This section gives a brief background on

  electronic commerce and the benefits IOTP offers.

o Section 2 - Introduction: This section describes the various

  Trading Exchanges and shows how these trading exchanges are used
  to construct the IOTP Transactions. This section also explains
  various Trading Roles that would participate in electronic trade.

o Section 3 - Protocol Structure: This section summarises how

  various IOTP transactions are constructed using the Trading Blocks
  and Trading Components that are the fundamental building blocks
  for IOTP transactions. All IOTP transaction messages are well
  formed XML documents.

o Section 4 - IOTP Error Handling: This section describes how to

  process exceptions and errors during the protocol message exchange
  and trading exchange processing. This section provides a generic
  overview of the exception handling. This section should be read
  carefully.

o Section 5 - Security Considerations: This section considers from

  an IETF perspective, how IOTP addresses security. It includes: how
  to determine whether to use digital signatures with IOTP, how IOTP
  address data privacy, and how security built into payment
  protocols relate to IOTP security.

o Section 6 - Digital Signatures and IOTP: This section provides an

  overview of how IOTP uses digital signatures; how to check a
  signature is correctly calculated and how the various Trading
  Roles that participate in trade should check signatures when
  required.

o Section 7 - Trading Components: This section defines the XML

  elements required by Trading Components.

o Section 8 - Trading Blocks: This section describes how Trading

  Blocks are constructed from Trading Components.

o Section 9 - Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions: This

  section describes all the IOTP Baseline transactions. It refers to
  Trading Blocks and Trading Components and Signatures. This section
  doesn't directly link error handling during the protocol
  exchanges, the reader is advised to understand Error Handling as
  defined in section before reading this section.

o Section 10 - Retrieving Logos: This section describes how IOTP

  specific logos can be retrieved.

o Section 11 - Brands: This section provides: an overview of Brand

  Definitions and Brand Selection which describe how a Consumer can
  select a Brand from a list provided by the Merchant; as well as
  some examples of Brand Lists.

o Section 12 - IANA Considerations: This section describes how new

  values for codes used by IOTP are co-ordinated.

o Section 13 - Internet Open Trading Protocol Data Type Definition:

  This section contains the XML Data Type Definitions for IOTP.

o Section 14 - Glossary. This describes all the major terminology

  used by IOTP.

o Section 15 - A list of the other documents referenced by the IOTP

  specification.

o Section 16 - The Author's Address

o Section 17 - Full Copyright Statement

Intended Readership

Software and hardware developers; development analysts; business and technical planners; industry analysts; merchants; bank and other payment handlers; owners, custodians, and users of payment protocols.

Reading Guidelines

This IOTP specification is structured primarily in a sequence targeted at people who want to understand the principles of IOTP. However from practical implementation experience by implementers of earlier of versions of the protocol new readers who plan to implement IOTP may prefer to read the document in a different sequence as described below.

Review the transport independent parts of the specification. This covers:

o Section 14 - Glossary

o Section 1 - Background

o Section 2 - Introduction

o Section 3 - Protocol Structure

o Section 4 - IOTP Error Handling

o Section 5 - Security Considerations

o Section 9 - Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions

o Section 11 - Brands

o Section 12 - IANA Considerations

o Section 10 - Retrieving Logos

Review the detailed XML definitions:

o Section 8 - Trading Blocks

o Section 7 - Trading Components

o Section 6 - Digital Signatures and IOTP

Introduction

The Internet Open Trading Protocols (IOTP) define a number of different types of IOTP Transactions:

o Purchase. This supports a purchase involving an offer, a payment

  and optionally a delivery

o Refund. This supports the refund of a payment as a result of,

  typically, an earlier purchase

o Value Exchange. This involves two payments which result in the

  exchange of value from one combination of currency and payment
  method to another

o Authentication. This supports one organisation or individual to

  check that another organisation or individual are who they appear
  to be.

o Withdrawal. This supports the withdrawal of electronic cash from a

  financial institution

o Deposit. This supports the deposit of electronic cash at a

  financial institution

o Inquiry. This supports inquiries on the status of an IOTP

  transaction which is either in progress or is complete

o Ping. This supports a simple query which enables one IOTP aware

  application to determine whether another IOTP application running
  elsewhere is working or not.

These IOTP Transactions are "Baseline" transactions since they have been identified as a minimum useful set of transactions. Later versions of IOTP may include additional types of transactions.

Each of the IOTP Transactions above involve:

o a number of organisations playing a Trading Role, and

o a set of Trading Exchanges. Each Trading Exchange involves the

  exchange of data, between Trading Roles, in the form of a set of
  Trading Components.

Trading Roles, Trading Exchanges and Trading Components are described below.

Trading Roles

The Trading Roles identify the different parts which organisations can take in a trade. The five Trading Roles used within IOTP are illustrated in the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
          Merchant Customer Care Provider resolves   ----------
     ---------------------------------------------->| Merchant |
    |          Consumer disputes and problems       |Cust.Care.|
    |                                               | Provider |
    |                                                ----------
    |
               Payment Handler accepts or makes     ----------
    |    ------------------------------------------>| Payment  |
    |   |             Payment for Merchant          | Handler  |
    |   |                                            ----------
    v   v
----------    Consumer makes purchases or obtains    ----------

| Consumer |<--------------------------------------->| Merchant |

----------             refund from Merchant          ----------
    ^
    |         Delivery Handler supplies goods or     ----------
    |---------------------------------------------->|Deliverer |
                   services for Merchant            | Handler  |
                                                     ----------
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                Figure 1 IOTP Trading Roles

The roles are:

o Consumer. The person or organisation which is to receive and pay

  for the goods or services

o Merchant. The person or organisation from whom the purchase is

  being made and who is legally responsible for providing the goods
  or services and receives the benefit of the payment made

o Payment Handler. The entity that physically receives the payment

  from the Consumer on behalf of the Merchant

o Delivery Handler. The entity that physically delivers the goods or

  services to the Consumer on behalf of the Merchant.

o Merchant Customer Care Provider. The entity that is involved with

  customer dispute negotiation and resolution on behalf of the
  Merchant

Roles may be carried out by the same organisation or different organisations. For example:

o in the simplest case one physical organisation (e.g., a merchant)

  could handle the purchase, accept the payment, deliver the goods
  and provide merchant customer care

o at the other extreme, a merchant could handle the purchase but

  instruct the consumer to pay a bank or financial institution,
  request that delivery be made by an overnight courier firm and to
  contact an organisation which provides 24x7 service if problems
  arise.

Note that in this specification, unless stated to the contrary, when the words Consumer, Merchant, Payment Handler, Delivery Handler or Customer Care Provider are used, they refer to the Trading Role rather than an actual organisation.

An individual organisation may take multiple roles. For example a company which is selling goods and services on the Internet could take the role of Merchant when selling goods or services and the role of Consumer when the company is buying goods or services itself.

As roles occur in different places there is a need for the organisations involved in the trade to exchange data, i.e. to carry out Trading Exchanges, so that the trade can be completed.

Trading Exchanges

The Internet Open Trading Protocols identify four Trading Exchanges which involve the exchange of data between the Trading Roles. The Trading Exchanges are:

o Offer. The Offer Exchange results in the Merchant providing the

  Consumer with the reason why the trade is taking place. It is
  called an Offer since the Consumer must accept the Offer if a
  trade is to continue

o Payment. The Payment Exchange results in a payment of some kind

  between the Consumer and the Payment Handler. This may occur in
  either direction

o Delivery. The Delivery Exchange transmits either the on-line

  goods, or delivery information about physical goods from the
  Delivery Handler to the Consumer, and

o Authentication. The Authentication Exchange can be used by any

  Trading Role to authenticate another Trading Role to check that
  they are who they appear to be.

IOTP Transactions are composed of various combinations of these Trading Exchanges. For example, an IOTP Purchase transaction includes Offer, Payment, and Delivery Trading Exchanges. As another example, an IOTP Value Exchange transaction is composed of an Offer Trading Exchange and two Payment Trading Exchanges.

Trading Exchanges consist of Trading Components that are transmitted between the various Trading Roles. Where possible, the number of round-trip delays in an IOTP Transaction is minimised by packing the Components from several Trading Exchanges into combination IOTP Messages. For example, the IOTP Purchase transaction combines a Delivery Organisation Component with an Offer Response Component in order to avoid an extra Consumer request and response.

Each of the IOTP Trading Exchanges is described in more detail below. For clarity of description, these describe the Trading Exchanges as though they were standalone operations. For performance reasons, the Trading Exchanges are intermingled in the actual IOTP Transaction definitions.

Offer Exchange

The goal of the Offer Exchange is for the Merchant to provide the Consumer with information about the trade so that the Consumer can decide whether to continue with the trade. This is illustrated in the figure below.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

Consumer

 |  Merchant

STEP | |

1.          Consumer decides to trade and sends information about the
         transaction (requests an offer) to the Merchant e.g.,
         using HTML.
 C --> M Data: Information on what is being purchased (Offer Request)
         - outside scope of IOTP
2.          Merchant checks the information provided by the Consumer,
         creates an Offer optionally signs it and sends it to the
         Consumer.
 C <-- M OFFER RESPONSE. Components: Status; Organisation(s)
         (Consumer, DelivTo, Merchant, Payment Handler, Customer
         Care); Order; Payment; Delivery; TradingRoleData (optional)
         Offer Response Signature (optional) that signs other
         components
3.          Consumer checks the information from the Merchant and
         decides whether to continue.
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                       Figure 2 Offer Exchange

An Offer Exchange uses the following Trading Components that are passed between the Consumer and the Merchant:

o the Status component is used to indicate to other parties that a

  valid Offer Response has been generated

o the Organisation Component contains information which describes

  the Organisations which are taking a role in the trade:
  -  the consumer provides information, about who the consumer is
     and, if goods or services are being delivered, where the goods
     or services are to be delivered to
  -  the merchant augments this information by providing information
     about the merchant, the Payment Handler, the customer care
     provider and, if goods or services are being delivered, the
     Delivery Handler

o the Order Component contains descriptions of the goods or services

  which will result from the trade if the consumer agrees to the
  offer.  This information is sent by the Merchant to the consumer
  who should verify it

o the Payment Component generated by the Merchant, contains details

  of how much to pay, the currency and the payment direction, for
  example the consumer could be asking for a refund. Note that there
  may be more than one payment in a trade

o the Delivery Component, also generated by the Merchant, is used if

  goods or services are being delivered. This contains information
  about how delivery will occur, for example by post or using e-mail

o the Trading Role Data component contains data the Merchant wants

  to forward to another Trading Role such as a Payment Handler or
  Delivery Handler

o the "Offer Response" Signature Component, if present, digitally

  signs all of the above components to ensure their integrity.

The exact content of the information provided by the Merchant to the Consumer will vary depending on the type of IOTP Transaction. For example:

o low value purchases may not need a signature

o the amount to be paid may vary depending on the payment brand and

  payment protocol used

o some offers may not involve the delivery of any goods

o a value exchange will involve two payments

o a merchant may not offer customer care.

Information provided by the consumer to the merchant is provided using a variety of methods, for example, it could be provided:

o using [HTML] pages as part of the "shopping experience" of the

  consumer.

o Using the Open Profiling Standard [OPS] which has recently been

  proposed,

o in the form of Organisation Components associated with an

  authentication of a Consumer by a Merchant

o as Order Components in a later version of IOTP.

Payment Exchange

The goal of the Payment Exchange is for a payment to be made from the Consumer to a Payment Handler or vice versa using a payment brand and payment protocol selected by the Consumer. A secondary goal is to optionally provide the Consumer with a digitally signed Payment Receipt which can be used to link the payment to the reason for the payment as described in the Offer Exchange.

Payment Exchanges can work in a variety of ways. The most general case where the trade is dependent on the payment brand and protocol used is illustrated in the diagram below. Simpler payment exchanges are possible.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
 Consumer  Pay Handler
 |  Merchant |

STEP | | |

1.                 Consumer decides to trade and sends information
                about the transaction (requests an offer) to the
                Merchant e.g., using HTML.
 C --> M        Information on what is being paid for (outside
                scope of IOTP
2.                 Merchant decides which payment brand, payment
                protocols and currencies/amounts to offer,
                places then in a Brand List Component and sends
                them to the Consumer
 C <-- M        Components: Brand List
3.                 Consumer selects the payment brand, protocol and
                currency/amount to use, creates a Brand Selection
                component and sends it to the Merchant
 C --> M        Component: Brand List Selection
4.                 Merchant checks Brand Selection, creates a Payment
                Amount information, optionally signs it to
                authorise payment and sends it to the Consumer
 C <-- M        Component: Payment; Organisation(s) (Merchant and
                Payment Handler); Optional Offer Response Signature
                that signs other components
5.                 Consumer checks the Payment Amount information and
                if OK requests that the payment starts by sending
                information to the Payment Handler
 C --------> P  PAYMENT REQUEST. Components: Status, Payment;
                Organisations (Merchant and Payment Handler);
                Trading Role Data (optional); Optional Offer
                Response Signature that signs other components;
                Pay Scheme Data
6.                 Payment Handler checks information including
                optional signature and if OK starts exchanging Pay
                Scheme Data components for selected payment brand
                and payment protocol
 C <-------> P  PAYMENT EXCHANGE. Component: Pay Scheme Data
7.                 Eventually payment protocol messages finish so
                Payment Handler sends Pay Receipt and optional
                signature to the Consumer as proof of payment
 C <-------> P  PAYMENT RESPONSE. Components: Status, Pay Receipt;
                Payment Note; Trading Role Data (optional);
                Optional Offer Response Signature; Optional
                Payment Receipt Signature that binds the payment
                to the Offer
8.                 Consumer checks Payment Receipt is OK
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                      Figure 3 Payment Exchange

A Payment Exchange uses the following Trading Components that are passed between the Consumer, the Merchant and the Payment Handler:

o The Brand List Component contains a list of payment brands (for

  example, MasterCard, Visa, Mondex, GeldKarte), payment protocols
  (for example SET Version 1.0, Secure Channel Credit Debit (SCCD -
  the name used for a credit or debit card payment where
  unauthorised access to account information is prevented through
  use of secure channel transport mechanisms such as SSL/TLS) as
  well as currencies/amounts that apply. The Merchant sends the
  Brand List to the Consumer. The consumer compares the payment
  brands, protocols and currencies/amounts on offer with those that
  the Consumer supports and makes a selection.

o The Brand Selection Component contains the Consumer's selection.

  Payment brand, protocol, currency/amount and possibly protocol-
  specific information is sent back to the Merchant. This
  information may be used to change information in the Offer
  Exchange. For example, a merchant could choose to offer a discount
  to encourage the use of a store card.

o the Status component is used to indicate to the Payment Handler

  that an earlier exchange (e.g., an Offer Exchange) has
  successfully completed and by the Payment Handler to indicate the
  completion status of the Payment Exchange.

o The Organisation Components are generated by the Merchant. They

  contain details of the Merchant and Payment Handler Roles:
  -  the Merchant role is required so that the Payment Handler can
     identify which Merchant initiated the payment. Typically, the
     result of the Payment Handler accepting (or making) a payment
     on behalf of the Merchant will be a credit or debit transaction
     to the Merchant's account held by the Payment Handler. These
     transactions are outside the scope of this version of IOTP
  -  the Payment Handler role is required so that the Payment
     Handler can check that it is the correct Payment Handler to be
     used for the payment

o The Payment Component contains details of how much to pay, the

  currency and the payment direction

o The "Offer Response" Signature Component, if present, digitally

  signs all of the above components to ensure their integrity. Note
  that the Brand List and Brand Selection Components are not signed
  until the payment information is created (step 4 in the diagram)

o the Trading Role Data component contains from other roles (e.g., a

  Merchant) that needs to be  forwarded to the Payment Handler

o The Payment Scheme Component contains messages from the payment

  protocol used in the Trade. For example they could be SET
  messages, Mondex messages, GeldKarte Messages or one of the other
  payment methods supported by IOTP. The content of the Payment
  Scheme Component is defined in the supplements that describe how
  IOTP works with various payment protocols.

o The Payment Receipt Component contains a record of the payment.

  The content depends upon the payment protocol used.

o The "Payment Receipt" Signature Component provides proof of

  payment by digitally signing both the Payment Receipt Component
  and the Offer Response Signature. The signature on the offer
  digitally signs the Order, Organisation and Delivery Components
  contained in the Offer.  This signature effectively binds the
  payment to the offer.

The example of a Payment Exchange above is the most general case. Simpler cases are also possible. For example, if the amount paid is not dependent on the payment brand and protocol selected then the payment information generated by step 3 can be sent to the Consumer at the same time as the Brand List Component generated by step 1. These and other variations are described in the Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction (see section 9.1.8).

Delivery Exchange

The goal of the Delivery Exchange is to cause purchased goods to be delivered to the consumer either online or via physical delivery. A second goal is to provide a "delivery note" to the consumer, providing details about the delivery, such as shipping tracking number. The result of the delivery may also be signed so that it can be used for customer care in the case of problems with physical delivery. The message flow is illustrated in the diagram below.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
 CONSUMER  DELIVERY
 |        HANDLER
 |  Merchant |

STEP | | |

1.                 Consumer decides to trade and sends information
                about what to deliver and who is to take delivery,
                to the Merchant e.g., using HTML.
 C --> M        Information on what is being delivered (outside
                scope of IOTP)
2.                 Merchant checks the information provided by the
                Consumer, adds information about how the delivery
                will occur, information about the Organisations
                involved in the delivery and optionally sings it
                and sends it to the Consumer
 C <-- M        Components: Delivery; Organisations (Delivery
                Handler, Deliver To); Order, Optional Offer
                Response Signature
3.                 Consumer checks delivery information is OK,
                obtains authorisation for the delivery, for
                example by making a payment, and sends the
                delivery information to the Delivery Handler
 C --------> D  DELIVERY REQUEST. Components: Status; Delivery,
                Organisations: (Merchant, Delivery Handler,
                DelivTo); Order, Trading Role Data (optional);
                Optional Offer Response Signature, Optional
                Payment Receipt Signature (from Payment Exchange)
4.                 Delivery Handler checks information and
                authorisation. Starts or schedules delivery and
                creates and then sends a delivery not tot the
                Consumer which can optionally be signed.
 C <-------- D  DELIVERY RESPONSE. Components: Status; Delivery
                Note, Trading Role Data (optional); Optional
                Delivery Response Signature
5.                 Consumer checks delivery note is OK and accepts or
                waits for delivery as described in the the Delivery
                Note.
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                     Figure 4 Delivery Exchange

A Delivery Exchange uses the following Trading Components that are passed between the Consumer, the Merchant and the Delivery Handler:

o the Status component is used to indicate to the Delivery Handler

  that an earlier exchange (e.g., an Offer Exchange or Payment
  Exchange) has successfully completed and by the Delivery Handler
  to indicate the completion status of the Delivery Exchange.

o The Organisation Component(s) contain details of the Deliver To,

  Delivery Handler and Merchant Roles:
  -  the Deliver To role indicates where the goods or services are
     to be delivered to
  -  the Delivery Handler role is required so that the Delivery
     Handler can check that she is the correct Delivery Handler to
     do the delivery
  -  the Merchant role is required so that the Delivery Handler can
     identify which Merchant initiated the delivery

o The Order Component, contains information about the goods or

  services to be delivered

o The Delivery Component contains information about how delivery

  will occur, for example by post or using e-mail.

o The "Offer Response" Signature Component, if present, digitally

  signs all of the above components to ensure their integrity.

o The "Payment Receipt" Signature Component provides proof of

  payment by digitally signing the Payment Receipt Component and the
  Offer Signature. This is used by the Delivery Handler to check
  that delivery is authorised

o The Delivery Note Component contains customer care information

  related to a physical delivery, or alternatively the actual
  "electronic goods".  The Consumer's software does not interpret
  information about a physical delivery but should have the ability
  to display the information, both at the time of the delivery and
  later if the Consumer selects the Trade to which this delivery
  relates from a transaction list

o The "Delivery Response" Signature Component, if present, provides

  proof of the results of the Delivery by digitally signing the
  Delivery Note and any Offer Response or Payment Response
  signatures that the Delivery Handler received.

Authentication Exchange

The goal of the Authentication Exchange is to allow one Organisation, for example a financial institution, to be able to check that another Organisation, for example a consumer, is who they appear to be.

An Authentication Exchange involves:

o an Authenticator - the Organisation which is requesting the

  authentication, and

o an Authenticatee - the Organisation being authenticated.

This is illustrated in the diagram below.

+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Organisation 1
(Authenticatee)
 |   Organisation 2
 |  (Authenticator)

STEP | |

1.          First Organisation, e.g., a Consumer, takes an action (for
         example by pressing a button on an HTML page) which
         requires that the Organisation is authenticated
 1 --> 2 Need for Authentication (outside scope of IOTP)
2.          The second Organisation generates an Authentication
         Request - including challenge data, and a list of the
         algorithms that may be used for the authentication -
         and/or a request for the Organisation information then
         sends it to the first Organisation
 1 <-- 2 AUTHENTICATION REQUEST. Components: Authentication
         Request, Trading Role Information Request
3.          The first Organisation optionally checks any signature
         associated with the Authentication Request then uses the
         specified authentication algorithm to generate an
         Authentication Response which is sent back to the second
         Organisation together with details of any Organisation
         information requested
 1 --> 2 AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE. Component: Authentication
         Response, Organisation(s)
4.          The Authentication Response is checked against the
         challenge data to check that the first Organisation is
         who they appear to be and the result recorded in a Status
         Component which is then sent back to the first
         Organisation.
 1 <-- 2 AUTHENTICATION STATUS. Component: Status
5.          The first Organisation then optionally checks the results
         indicated by the Status and any associated signature and
         takes the appropriate action or stops.
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                  Figure 5 Authentication Exchange

An Authentication Exchange uses the following Trading Components that are passed between the two Organisations:

o the Authentication Request Component that requests an

  Authentication and indicates the authentication algorithm and
  optional challenge data to be used.

o A Trading Role Information Request Component that requests

  information about an Organisation, for example a ship to address.

o The Authentication Response Component which contains the challenge

  response generated by the recipient of the Authentication Request
  Component.

o Organisation Components that contain the result of the Trading

  Role Information Request

o the Status Component which contains the results of the second

  party's verification of the Authentication Response.

Scope of Baseline IOTP

This specification describes the IOTP Transactions which make up Baseline IOTP. As described in the preface, IOTP will evolve over time. This section defines the initial conformance criteria for implementations that claim to "support IOTP."

The main determinant on the scope of an IOTP implementation is the roles which the solution is designed to support. The roles within IOTP are described in more detail in section 2.1 Trading Roles. To summarise the roles are: Merchant, Consumer, Payment Handler, Delivery Handler and Customer Care Provider.

Payment Handlers who can be of three types:

o those who accept a payment as part of a purchase or make a payment

  as part of a refund,

o those who accept value as part of a deposit transaction, or

o those that issue value a withdrawal transaction

The following table defines, for each role, the IOTP Transactions and Trading Blocks which must be supported for that role.

                   Merchants
                    ECash    ECash
            Store   Value    Value    Consumer  Payment   Delivery
                    Issuer Acquirer             Handler   Handler
TRANSACTIONS

Purchase Must Must

                   Merchants
                    ECash    ECash
            Store   Value    Value    Consumer  Payment   Delivery
                    Issuer Acquirer             Handler   Handler

Refund Must b)

                                      Depends

Authentication May Must May b)

                                      Depends

Value Exchange May Must

Withdrawal Must b)

                                      Depends

Deposit Must b)

                                      Depends

Inquiry Must Must Must May Must Must

Ping Must Must Must May Must Must

TRADING BLOCKS

TPO Must Must Must Must

TPO Selection Must Must Must Must

Auth-Request a) a) a)

           Depends          Depends   Depends

Auth-Reply a) a) a)

           Depends          Depends   Depends

Offer Response Must Must Must Must

Payment Must Must Request

Payment Must Must Exchange

Payment Must Must Response

Delivery Must Must Request

Delivery Must Must Response

                   Merchants
                    ECash    ECash
            Store   Value    Value    Consumer  Payment   Delivery
                    Issuer Acquirer             Handler   Handler

Inquiry Must Must Must Must Must Must Request

Inquiry Must Must Must Must Must Must Response

Ping Request Must Must Must Must Must Must

Ping Response Must Must Must Must Must Must

Signature Must Must Must Limited Must Must

Error Must Must Must Must Must Must

In the above table:

o "Must" means that a Trading Role must support the Transaction or

  Trading Block.

o "May" means that an implementation may support the Transaction or

  Trading Block at the option of the developer.

o "Depends" means implementation of the Transaction or Trading Block

  depends on one of the following conditions:
  -  if Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction is supported;
  -  if required by a Payment Method as defined in its IOTP
     Supplement document.

o "Limited" means the Trading Block must be understood and its

  content manipulated but not in every respect. Specifically, on the
  Signature Block, Consumers do not have to be able to validate
  digital signatures.

An IOTP solution must support all the IOTP Transactions and Trading Blocks required by at least one role (column) as described in the above table for that solution to be described as "supporting IOTP".

Protocol Structure

The previous section provided an introduction which explained:

o Trading Roles which are the different roles which Organisations

  can take in a trade: Consumer, Merchant, Payment Handler, Delivery
  Handler and Customer Care Provider, and

o Trading Exchanges where each Trading Exchange involves the

  exchange of data, between Trading Roles, in the form of a set of
  Trading Components.

This section describes:

o how Trading Components are constructed into Trading Blocks and the

  IOTP Messages which are physically sent in the form of [XML]
  documents between the different Trading Roles,

o how IOTP Messages are exchanged between Trading Roles to create an

  IOTP Transaction

o the XML definitions of an IOTP Message including a Transaction

  Reference Block - an XML element which identifies an IOTP
  Transaction and the IOTP Message within it

o the definitions of the XML ID Attributes which are used to

  identify IOTP Messages, Trading Blocks and Trading Components and
  how these are referred to using Element References from other XML
  elements

o how extra XML Elements and new user defined values for existing

  IOTP codes can be used when Extending IOTP,

o how IOTP uses the Packaged Content Element to embed data such as

  payment protocol messages or detailed order definitions within an
  IOTP Message

o how IOTP Identifies Languages so that different languages can be

  used within IOTP Messages

o how IOTP handles both Secure and Insecure Net Locations when

  sending messages

o how an IOTP Transaction can be cancelled.

Overview

IOTP Message Structure

The structure of an IOTP Message and its relationship with Trading Blocks and Trading Components is illustrated in the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

IOTP MESSAGE <---------- IOTP Message - an XML Document which is

|                        transported between the Trading Roles
|-Trans Ref Block <----- Trans Ref Block - contains information which
|  |                     describes the IOTP Transaction and the IOTP
|  |                     Message.
|  |-Trans Id Comp. <--- Transaction Id Component - uniquely
|  |                     identifies the IOTP Transaction. The Trans Id
|  |                     Components are the same across all IOTP
|  |                     messages that comprise a single IOTP
|  |                     transaction.
|  |-Msg Id Comp. <----- Message Id Component - identifies and
|                        describes an IOTP Message within an IOTP
|                        Transaction
|-Signature Block <----- Signature Block (optional) - contains one or
|  |                     more Signature Components and their
|  |                     associated Certificates
|  |-Signature Comp. <-- Signature Component - contains digital
|  |                     signatures. Signatures may sign digests of
|  |                     the Trans Ref Block and any Trading Component
|  |                     in any IOTP Message in the same IOTP
|  |                     transaction.
|  |-Certificate Comp. < Certificate Component (Optional) Used to check
|                        the signature.
|-Trading Block <------- Trading Block - an XML Element within an IOTP
|  |-Trading Comp.       Message that contains a predefined set of
|  |-Trading Comp.      Trading Components
|  |-Trading Comp.
|  |-Trading Comp. <--- Trading Components - XML Elements within a
|                        Trading Block that contain a predefined set
|-Trading Block          of XML elements and attributes containing
|  |-Trading Comp.       information required to support a Trading
|  |-Trading Comp.       Exchange
|  |-Trading Comp.
|  |-Trading Comp.
|  |-Trading Comp.
  • -*-*-*-*-*--*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                  Figure 6 IOTP Message Structure

The diagram also introduces the concept of a Transaction Reference Block. This block contains, amongst other things, a globally unique identifier for the IOTP Transaction. Also each block and component is given an ID Attribute (see section 3.4) which is unique within an IOTP Transaction. Therefore the combination of the ID attribute and

the globally unique identifier in the Transaction Reference Block is sufficient to uniquely identify any Trading Block or Trading Component.

IOTP Transactions

A predefined set of IOTP Messages exchanged between the Trading Roles constitute an IOTP Transaction. This is illustrated in the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
 CONSUMER                                              MERCHANT
                                                   Generate first
                                                    IOTP Message
                               ---                        |
                              |   |                       v
Process incoming                 | I |                 -------------
 IOTP Message &   <------------- |   | ------------ | IOTP Message |

generate next IOTP | | -------------

 Message                      | N |
    |                         |   |
    v                         |   |
 -------------                   | T |              Process incoming
| IOTP Message |  -------------- |   | ----------->  IOTP Message &
 -------------                   |   |                 generate next
                              | E |                  IOTP Message
                              |   |                       |
                              |   |                       v
Process incoming                 | R |                 -------------

IOTP Message <------------- | | ------------ | IOTP Message | generate last IOTP | | -------------

 Message & stop                  | N |
    |                         |   |
    v                         |   |
 -------------                   | E |                  Process last
| IOTP Message |  -------------- |   | ------------->  incoming IOTP
 -------------                   |   |                Message & stop
    |                         | T |                       |
    v                         |   |                       v
   STOP                        ---                       STOP
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-
                   Figure 7 An IOTP Transaction

In the above diagram the Internet is shown as the transport mechanism. This is not necessarily the case. IOTP Messages can be transported using a variety of transport mechanisms.

The IOTP Transactions (see section 9) in this version of IOTP are specifically:

o Purchase. This supports a purchase involving an offer, a payment

  and optionally a delivery

o Refund. This supports the refund of a payment as a result of,

  typically, an earlier purchase

o Value Exchange. This involves two payments which result in the

  exchange of value from one combination of currency and payment
  method to another

o Authentication. This supports the remote authentication of one

  Trading Role by another Trading Role using a variety of
  authentication algorithms, and the provision of an Organisation
  Information about the Trading Role that is being authenticated for
  use in, for example, the creation of an offer

o Withdrawal. This supports the withdrawal of electronic cash from a

  financial institution

o Deposit. This supports the deposit of electronic cash at a

  financial institution

o Inquiry This supports inquiries on the status of an IOTP

  transaction which is either in progress or is complete

o Ping This supports a simple query which enables one IOTP aware

  application to determine whether another IOTP application running
  elsewhere is working or not.

IOTP Message

As described earlier, IOTP Messages are [XML] documents which are physically sent between the different Trading Roles that are taking part in a trade.

The XML definition of an IOTP Message is as follows.

<!ELEMENT IotpMessage

  ( TransRefBlk,
    SigBlk?,
    ErrorBlk?,
    ( AuthReqBlk |
      AuthRespBlk |
      AuthStatusBlk |
      CancelBlk |
      DeliveryReqBlk |
      DeliveryRespBlk |
      InquiryReqBlk |
      InquiryRespBlk |
      OfferRespBlk |
      PayExchBlk |
      PayReqBlk |
      PayRespBlk |
      PingReqBlk |
      PingRespBlk |
      TpoBlk |
      TpoSelectionBlk
    )*
  ) >

<!ATTLIST IotpMessage

 xmlns                     CDATA
 'iotp:ietf.org/iotp-v1.0'

Content:

TransRefBlk This contains information which describes an IOTP

                  Message within an IOTP Transaction (see section
                  3.3 immediately below)

AuthReqBlk, These are the Trading Blocks. AuthRespBlk, DeliveryReqBlk, The Trading Blocks present within an IOTP Message, DeliveryRespBlk and the content of a Trading Block itself is ErrorBlk dependent on the type of IOTP Transaction being InquiryReqBlk, carried out - see the definition of each InquiryRespBlk, transaction in section 9 Internet Open Trading OfferRespBlk, Protocol Transactions. PayExchBlk, PayReqBlk, Full definitions of each Trading Block are PayRespBlk, described in section 8. PingReqBlk, PingRespBlk, SigBlk, TpoBlk, TpoSelectionBlk

Attributes:

xmlns The [XML Namespace] definition for IOTP messages.

XML Document Prolog

The IOTP Message is the root element of the XML document. It therefore needs to be preceded by an appropriate XML Document Prolog. For example:

<?XML Version='1.0'?> <!DOCTYPE IotpMessage > <IotpMessage>

...

</IotpMessage>

Transaction Reference Block

A Transaction Reference Block contains information which identifies the IOTP Transaction and IOTP Message. The Transaction Reference Block contains:

o a Transaction Id Component which globally uniquely identifies the

  IOTP Transaction. The Transaction Id Components are the same
  across all IOTP messages that comprise a single IOTP transaction,

o a Message Id Component which provides control information about

  the IOTP Message as well as uniquely identifying the IOTP Message
  within an IOTP Transaction, and

o zero or more Related To Components which link this IOTP

  Transaction to either other IOTP Transactions or other events
  using the identifiers of those events.

The definition of a Transaction Reference Block is as follows:

<!ELEMENT TransRefBlk (TransId, MsgId, RelatedTo*) > <!ATTLIST TransRefBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Transaction Reference Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction (see section 3.4 ID Attributes).

Content:

TransId See 3.3.1 Transaction Id Component immediately

                  below.

MsgId See 3.3.2 Message Id Component immediately below.

RelatedTo See 3.3.3 Related To Component immediately below.

Transaction Id Component

This contains information which globally uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction. Its definition is as follows:

<!ELEMENT TransId EMPTY > <!ATTLIST TransId

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
Version            NMTOKEN #FIXED '1.0'
IotpTransId        CDATA   #REQUIRED
IotpTransType      CDATA   #REQUIRED
TransTimeStamp     CDATA   #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Transaction Id Component within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Version This identifies the version of IOTP, and therefore

                  the structure of the IOTP Messages, which the IOTP
                  Transaction is using.

IotpTransId Contains data which uniquely identifies the IOTP

                  Transaction. It must conform to the rules for
                  Message Ids in [[[RFC822|RFC 822]]].

IotpTransTyp This is the type of IOTP Transaction being carried

                  out. For Baseline IOTP it identifies a "standard"
                  IOTP Transaction and implies the sequence and
                  content of the IOTP Messages exchanged between the
                  Trading Roles. The valid values for Baseline IOTP
                  are:
                   o BaselineAuthentication
                   o BaselineDeposit
                   o BaselinePurchase
                   o BaselineRefund
                   o BaselineWithdrawal
                   o BaselineValueExchange
                   o BaselineInquiry
                   o BaselinePing
                  Values of IotpTransType are managed under the
                  procedure described in section 12 IANA
                  Considerations which also allows user defined
                  values of IotpTransType to be defined.
                  In later versions of IOTP, this list will be
                  extended to support different types of standard
                  IOTP Transaction. It is also likely to support the
                  type Dynamic which indicates that the sequence of
                  steps within the transaction are non-standard.

TransTimeStamp Where the system initiating the IOTP Transaction

                  has an internal clock, it is set to the time at
                  which the IOTP Transaction started in [UTC]
                  format.
                  The main purpose of this attribute is to provide
                  an alternative way of identifying a transaction by
                  specifying the time at which it started.
                  Some systems, for example, hand held devices may
                  not be able to generate a  time stamp. In this
                  case this attribute should contain the value "NA"
                  for Not Available.

Message Id Component

The Message Id Component provides control information about the IOTP Message as well as uniquely identifying the IOTP Message within an IOTP Transaction. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT MsgId EMPTY > <!ATTLIST MsgId

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
RespIotpMsg        NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
LangPrefList       NMTOKENS #IMPLIED
CharSetPrefList    NMTOKENS #IMPLIED
SenderTradingRoleRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
SoftwareId         CDATA   #REQUIRED
TimeStamp          CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                      IOTP Message within the IOTP Transaction (see
                      section 3.4 ID Attributes). Note that if an
                      IOTP Message is resent then the value of this
                      attribute remains the same.

RespIotpMsg This contains the ID attribute of the Message

                      Id Component of the IOTP Message to which this
                      IOTP Message is a response. In this way all
                      the IOTP Messages in an IOTP Transaction are
                      unambiguously linked together. This field is
                      required on every IOTP Message except the
                      first IOTP Message in an IOTP Transaction.

SenderTradingRoleRef The Element Reference (see section 3.5) of the

                      Trading Role which has generated the IOTP
                      message. It is used to identify the Net
                      Locations (see section 3.9) of the Trading
                      Role to which problems Technical Errors (see
                      section 4.1) with any of Trading Blocks should
                      be reported.

Xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or

                      child elements within this component, unless
                      overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
                      element. See section 3.8 Identifying
                      Languages.

LangPrefList Optional list of Language codes that conform

                      to [XML] Language Identification. It is used
                      by the sender to indicate, in preference
                      sequence, the languages that the receiver of
                      the message ideally should use when generating
                      a response. There is no obligation on the
                      receiver to respond using one of the indicated
                      languages, but using one of the languages is
                      likely to provide an improved user experience.

CharSetPrefList Optional list of Character Set identifiers

                      that conform to [XML] Characters. It is used
                      by the sender to indicate, in preference
                      sequence, the character sets that the receiver
                      of the message ideally should use when
                      generating a response. There is no obligation
                      on the receiver to respond using one of the
                      character sets indicated, but using one of the
                      character sets is likely to provide an
                      improved user experience.

SoftwareId This contains information which identifies the

                      software which generated the IOTP Message. Its
                      purpose is to help resolve interoperability
                      problems that might occur as a result of
                      incompatibilities between messages produced by
                      different software. It is a single text string
                      in the language defined by xml:lang. It must
                      contain, as a minimum:
                      o the name of the software manufacturer
                      o the name of the software
                      o the version of the software, and
                      o the build of the software

TimeStamp Where the device sending the message has an

                      internal clock, it is set to the time at which
                      the IOTP Message was created in [UTC] format.

Related To Component

The Related To Component links IOTP Transactions to either other IOTP Transactions or other events using the identifiers of those events. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT RelatedTo (PackagedContent) > <!ATTLIST RelatedTo

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
RelationshipType   NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
Relation           CDATA   #REQUIRED
RelnKeyWords       NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Related To Component within the IOTP Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child

                  elements within this component, unless overridden
                  by an xml:lang attribute on a child element. See
                  section 3.8 Identifying Languages.

RelationshipType Defines the type of the relationship. Valid values

                  are:
                   o IotpTransaction. in which case the Packaged
                     Content Element contains an IotpTransId of
                     another IOTP Transaction
                   o Reference in which case the Packaged Content
                     Element contains the reference of some other,
                     non-IOTP document.
                  Values of RelationshipType are controlled under
                  the procedures defined in section 12 IANA
                  Considerations which also allows user defined
                  values to be defined.

Relation The Relation attribute contains a phrase in the

                  language defined by xml:lang which describes the
                  nature of the relationship between the IOTP
                  transaction that contains this component and
                  another IOTP Transaction or other event. The exact
                  words to be used are left to the implementers of
                  the IOTP software.
                  The purpose of the attribute is to provide the
                  Trading Roles involved in an IOTP Transaction with
                  an explanation of the nature of the relationship
                  between the transactions.
                  Care should be taken that the words used to in the
                  Relation attribute indicate the "direction" of the
                  relationship correctly. For example: one
                  transaction might be a refund for another earlier
                  transaction. In this case the transaction which is
                  a refund should contain in the Relation attribute
                  words such as "refund for" rather than "refund to"
                  or just "refund".

RelnKeyWords This attribute contains keywords which could be

                  used to help identify similar relationships, for
                  example all refunds. It is anticipated that
                  recommended keywords will be developed through
                  examination of actual usage. In this version of
                  the specification there are no specific
                  recommendations and the keywords used are at the
                  discretion of implementers.

Content:

PackagedContent The Packaged Content (see section 3.7) contains

                  data which identifies the related transaction. Its
                  format varies depending on the value of the
                  RelationshipType.

ID Attributes

IOTP Messages, Blocks (i.e. Transaction Reference Blocks and Trading Blocks), Trading Components (including the Transaction Id Component and the Signature Component) and some of their child elements are each given an XML "ID" attribute which is used to identify an instance of these XML elements. These identifiers are used so that one element can be referenced by another. All these attributes are given the attribute name ID.

The values of each ID attribute are unique within an IOTP transaction i.e. the set of IOTP Messages which have the same globally unique Transaction ID Component. Also, once the ID attribute of an element has been assigned a value it is never changed. This means that whenever an element is copied, the value of the ID attribute remains the same.

As a result it is possible to use these IDs to refer to and locate the content of any IOTP Message, Block or Component from any other IOTP Message, Block or Component in the same IOTP Transaction using Element References (see section 3.5).

This section defines the rules for setting the values for the ID attributes of IOTP Messages, Blocks and Components.

IOTP Message ID Attribute Definition

The ID attribute of the Message Id Component of an IOTP Message must be unique within an IOTP Transaction. It's definition is as follows:

IotpMsgId_value ::= IotpMsgIdPrefix IotpMsgIdSuffix IotpMsgIdPrefix ::= NameChar (NameChar)* IotpMsgIdSuffix ::= Digit (Digit)*

IotpMsgIdPrefix Apart from messages which contain: an Inquiry

                  Request Trading Block, an Inquiry Response Trading
                  Block, a Ping Request Trading Block or a Ping
                  Response Trading Block; then the same prefix is
                  used for all messages sent by the Merchant or
                  Consumer role as follows:
                   o "M" - Merchant
                   o "C" - Consumer
                  For messages which contain an Inquiry Request
                  Trading Block or a Ping Request Trading Block, the
                  prefix is set to "I" for Inquiry.
                  For messages which contain an Inquiry Response
                  Trading Block or a Ping Response Trading Block,
                  the prefix is set to "Q".
                  The prefix for the other roles in a trade is
                  contained within the Organisation Component for
                  the role and are typically set by the Merchant.
                  The following is recommended as a guideline and
                  must not be relied upon:
                   o "P" - First (only) Payment Handler
                   o "R" - Second Payment Handler
                   o "D" - Delivery Handler
                   o "C" - Deliver To
                  As a guideline, prefixes should be limited to one
                  character.
                  NameChar has the same definition as the [XML]
                  definition of NameChar.

IotpMsgIdSuffix The suffix consists of one or more digits. The

                  suffix must be unique within a Trading Role within
                  an IOTP Transaction. The following is recommended
                  as a guideline and must not be relied upon:
                   o the first IOTP Message sent by a trading role
                     is given the suffix "1"
                   o the second and subsequent IOTP Messages sent
                     by the same trading role are incremented by one
                     for each message
                   o no leading zeroes are included in the suffix
                  Put more simply the Message Id Component of the
                  first IOTP Message sent by a Consumer would have
                  an ID attribute of, "C1", the second "C2", the
                  third "C3" etc.
                  Digit has the same definition as the [XML]
                  definition of Digit.

Block and Component ID Attribute Definitions

The ID Attribute of Blocks and Components must also be unique within an IOTP Transaction. Their definition is as follows:

BlkOrCompId_value ::= IotpMsgId_value "." IdSuffix IdSuffix ::= Digit (Digit)*

IotpMsgId_value The ID attribute of the Message ID Component of

                  the IOTP Message where the Block or Component is
                  first used.
                  In IOTP, Trading Components and Trading Blocks are
                  copied from one IOTP Message to another. The ID
                  attribute does not change when an existing Trading
                  Block or Component is copied to another IOTP
                  Message.

IdSuffix The suffix consists of one or more digits. The

                  suffix must be unique within the ID attribute of
                  the Message ID Component used to generate the ID
                  attribute. The following is recommended as a
                  guideline and must not be relied upon:
                   o the first Block or Component sent by a trading
                     role is given the suffix "1"
                   o the ID attributes of the second and subsequent
                     Blocks or Components are incremented by one for
                     each new Block or Component added to an IOTP
                     Message
                   o no leading zeroes are included in the suffix
                  Put more simply, the first new Block or Component
                  added to the second IOTP Message sent, for
                  example, by a consumer would have a an ID
                  attribute of "C2.1", the second "C2.2", the third
                  "C2.3" etc.
                  Digit has the same definition as the [XML]
                  definition of Digit.

Example of use of ID Attributes

The diagram below illustrates how ID attribute values are used.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
  1st  IOTP MESSAGE                          2nd IOTP MESSAGE
(e.g., from Merchant to                    (e.g., from Consumer to
       Consumer                              Payment Handler)

IOTP MESSAGE IOTP MESSAGE *

|-Trans Ref Block. ID=M1.1                 |-Trans Ref Block.ID=C1.1*
|  |-Trans Id Comp. ID = M1.2 ------------>|  |-Trans Id Comp.
|  |                         Copy Element  |  |  ID=M1.2
|  |-Msg Id Comp. ID = M1                  |  |-Msg Id Comp. ID=C1 *
|                                          |
|-Signature Block. ID=M1.8                 |-Signature Block.ID=C1.5*
|  |-Sig Comp. ID=M1.15 ------------------>|  |-Comp. ID=M1.15
|                            Copy Element  |
|-Trading Block. ID=M1.3                   |-Trading Block.ID=C1.2 *
|  |-Comp. ID=M1.4 -------------------------->|-Comp. ID=M1.4
|  |                         Copy Element     |
|  |-Comp. ID=M1.5 -------------------------->|-Comp. ID=M1.5
|  |                         Copy Element     |
|  |-Comp. ID=M1.6                            |-Comp. ID=C1.3 *
|  |-Comp. ID=M1.7                            |-Comp. ID=C1.4 *
|
|-Trading Block. ID=M1.9
|-Comp. ID=M1.10                             * = new elements
|-Comp. ID=M1.11
|-Comp. ID=M1.12
|-Comp. ID=M1.13
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-
               Figure 8 Example use of ID attributes

Element References

A Trading Component or one of its child XML elements, may contain an XML attribute that refers to another Block (i.e. a Transaction Reference Block or a Trading Block) or Trading Component (including a Transaction Id and Signature Component). These Element References are used for many purposes, a few examples include:

o identifying an XML element whose Digest is included in a Signature

  Component,

o referring to the Payment Handler Organisation Component which is

  used when making a Payment

An Element Reference always contains the value of an ID attribute of a Block or Component.

Identifying the IOTP Message, Trading Block or Trading Component which is referred to by an Element Reference, involves finding the XML element which:

o belongs to the same IOTP Transaction (i.e. the Transaction Id

  Components of the IOTP Messages match), and

o where the value of the ID attribute of the element matches the

  value of the Element Reference.

Note: The term "match" in this specification has the same definition as the [XML] definition of match.

An example of "matching" an Element Reference is illustrated in the example below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
     1st  IOTP MESSAGE                          2nd IOTP MESSAGE
   (e.g., from Merchant to                    (e.g., from Consumer to
          Consumer                              Payment Handler)

IOTP MESSAGE IOTP MESSAGE

|-Trans Ref Block. ID=M1.1     Trans ID    |-Trans RefBlock. ID=C1.1
|  |-Trans Id Comp. ID = M1.2 <-Components-|->|-TransId Comp.ID=M1.2
|  |                            must be    |  |
|  |-Msg Id Comp. ID = M1      Identical   |  |-Msg Id Comp. ID=C1
|                                  ^       |
|-Signature Block. ID=M1.8         |       |-Signature Block.ID=C1.5
|  |-Sig Comp. ID=M1.15            |       |  |-Comp. ID=M1.15
|                                 AND      |
|-Trading Block. ID=M1.3           |       |-Trading Block. ID=C1.2
|  |-Comp. ID=M1.4                 |          |-Comp. ID=M1.4
|  |                               v          |
|  |-Comp. ID=M1.5 <-------- -ID Attribute    |-Comp. ID=M1.5
|  |                          and El Ref      |
|  |-Comp. ID=M1.6            values must     |-Comp. ID=C1.3
|  |                             match--------|--> El Ref=M1.5
|  |-Comp. ID=M1.7                            |-Comp. ID=C1.4
|
|-Trading Block. ID=M1.9
   |-Comp. ID=M1.10
   |-Comp. ID=M1.11
   |-Comp. ID=M1.12
   |-Comp. ID=M1.13
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-
                       Figure 9 Element References

Note: Element Reference attributes are defined as "NMTOKEN" rather than "IDREF" (see [XML]). This is because an IDREF requires that the XML element referred to is in the same XML Document. With IOTP this is not necessarily the case.

Extending IOTP

Baseline IOTP defines a minimum protocol which systems supporting IOTP must be able to accept. As new versions of IOTP are developed, additional types of IOTP Transactions will be defined. In addition to this, Baseline and future versions of IOTP will support user extensions to IOTP through two mechanisms:

o extra XML elements, and

o new values for existing IOTP codes.

Extra XML Elements

The XML element and attribute names used within IOTP constitute an [XML Namespace] as identified by the xmlns attribute on the IotpMessage element. This allows IOTP to support the inclusion of additional XML elements within IOTP messages through the use of [XML Namespaces].

Using XML Namespaces, extra XML elements may be included at any level within an IOTP message including:

o new Trading Blocks

o new Trading Components

o new XML elements within a Trading Component.

The following rules apply:

o any new XML element must be declared according to the rules for

  [XML Namespaces]

o new XML elements which are either Trading Blocks or Trading

  Components must contain an ID attributes with an attribute name of
  ID.

In order to make sure that extra XML elements can be processed properly, IOTP reserves the use of a special attribute, IOTP:Critical, which takes the values True or False and may appear in extra elements added to an IOTP message.

The purpose of this attribute is to allow an IOTP aware application to determine if the IOTP transaction can safely continue. Specifically:

o if an extra XML element has an "IOTP:Critical" attribute with a

  value of "True" and an IOTP aware application does not know how to
  process the element and its child elements, then the IOTP
  transaction has a Technical Error (see section 4.1) and must fail.

o if an extra XML element has an "IOTP:Critical" attribute with a

  value of "False" then the IOTP transaction may continue if the
  IOTP aware application does not know how to process it. In this
  case:
  -  any extra XML elements contained within an XML element defined
     within the IOTP namespace, must be included with that element
     whenever the IOTP XML element is used or copied by IOTP
  -  the content of the extra element must be ignored except that it
     must be included when it is used in the creation of a digest as
     part of the generation of a signature

o if an extra XML element has no "IOTP:Critical" attribute then it

  must be treated as if it had an "IOTP:Critical" attribute with a
  value of "True"

o if an XML element contains an "IOTP:Critical" attribute, then the

  value of that attribute is assumed to apply to all the child
  elements within that element

In order to ensure that documents containing "IOTP:Critical" are valid, it is declared as part of the DTD for the extra element as:

IOTP:Critical (True | False ) 'True'

Opaque Embedded Data

If IOTP is to be extended using Opaque Embedded Data then a Packaged Content Element (see section 3.7) should be used to encapsulate the data.

Packaged Content Element

The Packaged Content element supports the concept of an embedded data stream, transformed to both protect it against misinterpretation by transporting systems and to ensure XML compatibility. Examples of its use in IOTP include:

o to encapsulate payment scheme messages, such as SET messages,

o to encapsulate a description of an order, a payment note, or a

  delivery note.

In general it is used to encapsulate one or more data streams.

This data stream has three standardised attributes that allow for identification, decoding and interpretation of the contents. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PackagedContent (#PCDATA) > <!ATTLIST PackagedContent

Name             CDATA     #IMPLIED
Content          NMTOKEN   "PCDATA"
Transform (NONE|BASE64)    "NONE" >

Attributes:

Name Optional. Distinguishes between multiple

                  occurrences of Packaged Content Elements at the
                  same point in IOTP. For example:
                    <ABCD>
                      <PackagedContent Name='FirstPiece'>
                        snroasdfnas934k
                      </PackagedContent>
                      <PackagedContent Name='SecondPiece'>
                        dvdsjnl5poidsdsflkjnw45
                      </PackagedContent>
                    </ABCD>
                  The name attribute may be omitted, for example if
                  there is only one Packaged Content element.

Content This identifies what type of data is contained

                  within the Content of the Packaged Content
                  Element. The valid values for the Content
                  attribute are as follows:
                   o PCDATA. The content of the Packaged Content
                     Element can be treated as PCDATA with no
                     further processing.
                   o MIME. The content of the Packaged Content
                     Element is a complete MIME item. Processing
                     should include looking for MIME headers inside
                     the Packaged Content Element.
                   o MIME:mimetype. The content of the Packaged
                     Content Element is MIME content, with the
                     following header "Content-Type: mimetype".
                     Although it is possible to have MIME:mimetype
                     with the Transform attribute set to NONE, it is
                     far more likely to have Transform attribute set
                     to BASE64. Note that if Transform is NONE is
                     used, then the entire content must still
                     conform to PCDATA. Some characters will need to
                     be encoded either as the XML default entities,
                     or as numeric character entities.
                   o XML. The content of the Packaged Content
                     Element can be treated as an XML document.
                     Entities and CDATA sections, or Transform set
                     to BASE64, must be used to ensure that the
                     Packaged Content Element contents are
                     legitimate PCDATA.
                  Values of the Content attribute are controlled
                  under the procedures defined in section 12 IANA
                  Considerations which also allows user defined
                  values to be defined.

Transform This identifies the transformation that has been

                  done to the data before it was placed in the
                  content. Valid values are:
                   o NONE. The PCDATA content of the Packaged
                     Content Element is the correct representation
                     of the data. Note that entity expansion must
                     occur first (i.e. replacement of & and
                     	) before the data is examined. CDATA
                     sections may legitimately occur in a Packaged
                     Content Element where the Transform attribute
                     is set to NONE.
                   o BASE64. The PCDATA content of the Packaged
                     Content Element represents a BASE64 encoding of
                     the actual content.

Content:

PCDATA This is the actual data which has been embedded.

                  The format of the data and rules on how to decode
                  it are contained in the Content and the Transform
                  attributes

Note that any special details, especially custom attributes, must be represented at a higher level.

Packaging HTML

The packaged content may contain HTML. In this case the following conventions are followed:

o references to any documents, images or other things, such as

  sounds or web pages, which can affect the recipient's
  understanding of the data which is being packaged must refer to
  other Packaged Elements contained within the same parent element,
  e.g., an Order Description

o if more than one Packaged Content element is included within a

  parent element in order to meet the previous requirement, then the
  Name attribute of the top level Packaged Content from which
  references to all other Packaged Elements can be determined,
  should have a value of Main

o relative references to other documents, images, etc. from one

  Packaged Content element to another are realised by setting the
  value of the relative reference to the Name attribute of another
  Packaged Content element at the same level and within the same
  parent element

o no external references that require the reference to be resolved

  immediately should be used. As this could make the HTML difficult
  or impossible to display completely

o [MIME] is used to encapsulate the data inside each Packaged

  Element.  This means that the information in the MIME header used
  to identify the type of data which has been encapsulated and
  therefore how it should be displayed.

If the above conventions are not followed by, for example, including external references which must be resolved, then the recipient of the HTML should be informed.

Note: As an implementation guideline the values of the Name Attributes allocated to Packaged Content elements should make it possible to extract each Packaged Content into a directory and then display the HTML directly

Packaging XML

Support for XML is recommended. When XML needs to be displayed, for example to display the content of an Order Description to a Consumer, then implementers should follow the latest recommendations of the World Wide Web Consortium.

Note: At the time of writing this specification, standards are under development that specify XML style sheets that show how XML documents should be displayed. See:

o "Extensible Stylesheet Language (XSL) Specification" at

 http://www.w3.org/TR/WD-xsl, and

o "Associating stylesheets with XML documents" at

 http://www.w3.org/TR/xml-stylesheet.

Once these standards become W3C "Recommendations", then it is anticipated that this specification will be amended if practical.

Identifying Languages

IOTP uses [XML] Language Identification to specify which languages are used within the content and attributes of IOTP Messages.

The following principles have been used in order to determine which XML elements contain an xml:lang Attributes:

o a mandatory xml:lang attribute is contained on every Trading

  Component which contains attributes or content which may need to
  be displayed or printed in a particular language

o an optional xml:lang attribute is included on child elements of

  these Trading Components. In this case the value of xml:lang, if
  present, overrides the value for the Trading Component.

xml:lang attributes which follow these principles are included in the Trading Components and their child XML elements defined in section 7.

A sender of a message, typically a Consumer can indicate a preference for a language, and a character set by specifying a list of preferred languages/character sets in a Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2). Note that there is no obligation on the receiver of such a message to respond using one of the listed languages/character sets as they may not have the technology to be able to do it. It also means that the ability to handle these lists is not a requirement for conformance to this specification. However the ability to respond, for example using one of the stated languages/character sets is likely to provide a better user experience.

Secure and Insecure Net Locations

IOTP contains several "Net Locations" which identify places where, typically, IOTP Messages may be sent. Net Locations come in two types:

o "Secure" Net Locations which are net locations where privacy of

  data is secured using, for example, encryption methods such as
  [SSL/TLS], and

o "Insecure" Net Locations where privacy of data is not assured.

Note that either a Secure Net Location or an Insecure Net Location or both must be present.

If only one of the two Net Locations is present, then the one present must be used.

Where both types of net location are present then either may be used depending on the preference of the sender of the message.

3.10 Cancelled Transactions

Any Trading Role involved in an IOTP transaction may cancel that transaction at any time.

3.10.1 Cancelling Transactions

IOTP Transactions are cancelled by sending an IOTP message containing just a Cancel Block with an appropriate Status Component to the other Trading Role involved in the Trading Exchange.

Note: The Cancel Block can be sent asynchronously of any other IOTP Message. Specifically it can be sent either before sending or after receiving an IOTP Message from the other Trading Role

If an IOTP Transaction is cancelled during a Trading Exchange (i.e. the interval between sending a "request" block and receiving the matching "response" block) then the Cancel Block is sent to the same location as the next IOTP Message in the Trading Exchange would have been sent.

If a Consumer cancels a transaction after a Trading Exchange has completed (i.e. the "response" block for the Trading Exchange has been received), but before the IOTP Transaction has finished then the Consumer sends a Cancel Block with an appropriate Status Component to the net location identified by the SenderNetLocn or SecureSenderNetLocn contained in the Protocol Options Component (see section 7.1) contained in the TPO Block (see section 8.1) for the transaction. This is normally the Merchant Trading Role.

A Consumer should not send a Cancel Block after the IOTP Transaction has completed. Cancelling a complete transaction should be treated as a technical error.

After cancelling the IOTP Transaction, the Consumer should go to the net location specified by the CancelNetLocn attribute contained in the Trading Role Element for the Organisation that was sent the Cancel Block.

A non-Consumer Trading Role should only cancel a transaction:

o after a request block has been received and

o before the response block has been sent

If a non-Consumer Trading Role cancels a transaction at any other time it should be treated by the recipient as an error.

3.10.2 Handling Cancelled Transactions

If a Cancel Block is received by a Consumer at a point in the IOTP Transaction when cancellation is allowed, then the Consumer should stop the transaction.

If a Cancel Block is received by a non-Consumer role, then the Trading Role should anticipate that the Consumer may go to the location specified by the CancelNetLocn attribute contained in the Trading Role Element for the Trading Role.

IOTP Error Handling

IOTP is designed as a request/response protocol where each message is composed of a number of Trading Blocks which contain a number of Trading Components. There are several interrelated considerations in handling errors, re-transmissions, duplicates, and the like. These factors mean IOTP aware applications must manage message flows more complex than the simple request/response model. Also a wide variety of errors can occur in messages as well as at the transport level or in Trading Blocks or Components.

This section describes at a high level how IOTP handles errors, retries and idempotency. It covers:

o the different types of errors which can occur. This is divided

  into:
  -  "technical errors" which are independent of the purpose of the
     IOTP Message,
  -  "business errors" which indicate that there is a problem
     specific to the process (e.g., payment or delivery) which is
     being carried out, and

o the depth of the error which indicates whether the error is at the

  transport, message or block/component level

o how the different trading roles should handle the different types

  of messages which they may receive.

Technical Errors

Technical Errors are those which are independent of the meaning of the message. This means, they can affect any attempt at IOTP communication. Typically they are handled in a standard fashion with a limited number of standard options for the user. Specifically these are:

o retrying the transmission, or

o cancelling the transaction.

When communications are operating sufficiently well, a technical error is indicated by an Error Component (see section 7.21) in an Error Block (see section 8.17) sent by the party which detected the error in an IOTP message to the party which sent the erroneous message.

If communications are too poor, a message which was sent may not reach its destination. In this case a time-out might occur.

The Error Codes associated with Technical Errors are recorded in the Error Component which lists all the different technical errors which can be set.

Business Errors

Business Errors may occur when the IOTP messages are "technically" correct. They are connected with a particular process, for example, an offer, payment, delivery or authentication, where each process has a different set of possible business errors.

For example, "Insufficient funds" is a reasonable payment error but makes no sense for a delivery while "Back ordered" is a reasonable delivery error but not meaningful for a payment. Business errors are indicated in the Status Component (see section 7.16) of a "response block" of the appropriate type, for example a Payment Response Block or a Delivery Response Block. This allows whatever additional response related information is needed to accompany the error indication.

Business errors must usually be presented to the user so that they can decide what to do next. For example, if the error is insufficient funds in a Brand Independent Offer (see section 9.1.2.2), the user might wish to choose a different payment instrument/account of the same brand or a different brand or payment system. Alternatively, if

the IOTP based implementation allows it and it makes sense for that instrument, the user might want to put more funds into the instrument/account and try again.

Error Depth

The three levels at which IOTP errors can occur are the transport level, the message level, and the block level. Each is described below.

Transport Level

This level of error indicates a fundamental problem in the transport mechanism over which the IOTP communication is taking place.

All transport level errors are technical errors and are indicated by either an explicit transport level error indication, such as a "No route to destination" error from TCP/IP, or by a time out where no response has been received to a request.

The only reasonable automatic action when faced with transport level errors is to retry and, after some number of automatic retries, to inform the user.

The explicit error indications that can be received are transport dependent and the documentation for the appropriate IOTP Transport supplement should be consulted for errors and appropriate actions.

Appropriate time outs to use are a function of both the transport being used and of the payment system if the request encapsulates payment information. The transport and payment system specific documentation should be consulted for time out and automatic retry parameters. Frequently there is no way to directly inform the other party of transport level errors but they should generally be logged and if automatic recovery is unsuccessful and there is a human user, the user should be informed.

Message Level

This level of error indicates a fundamental technical problem with an entire IOTP message. For example, the XML is not "Well Formed", or the message is too large for the receiver to handle or there are errors in the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) so it is not possible to figure out what transaction the message relates to.

All message level errors are technical errors and are indicated by Error Components (see section 7.21) sent to the other party. The Error Component includes a Severity attribute which indicates whether

the error is a Warning and may be ignored, a TransientError which indicates that a retry may resolve the problem or a HardError in which case the transaction must fail.

The Technical Errors (see section 7.21.2 Error Codes) that are Message Level errors are:

o XML not well formed. The document is not well formed XML (see

  [XML])

o XML not valid. The document is not valid XML (see [XML])

o block level technical errors (see section 4.3.3) on the

  Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) and the Signature
  Block only. Checks on these blocks should only be carried out if
  the XML is valid

Note that checks on the Signature Block include checking, where possible, that each Signature Component is correctly calculated. If the Signature is incorrectly calculated then the data that should have been covered by the signature can not be trusted and must be treated as erroneous. A description of how to check a signature is correctly calculated is contained in section 6.2.

Block Level

A Block level error indicates a problem with a block or one of its components in an IOTP message (apart from Transaction Reference or Signature Blocks). The message has been transported properly, the overall message structure and the block/component(s) including the Transaction Reference and Signature Blocks are meaningful but there is some error related to one of the other blocks.

Block level errors can be either:

o technical errors, or

o business errors

Technical Errors are further divided into:

o Block Level Attribute and Element Checks, and

o Block and Component Consistency Checks

o Transient Technical Errors

If a technical error occurs related to a block or component, then an Error Component is generated for return.

Block Level Attribute and Element Checks

Block Level Attribute and Element Checks occur only within the same block. Checks which involve cross-checking against other blocks are covered by Block and Component Consistency Checks.

The Block Level Attribute & Element checks are:

o checking that each attribute value within each element in a block

  conforms to any rules contained within this IOTP specification

o checking that the content of each element conforms to any rules

  contained within this IOTP specification

o if the previous checks are OK, then checking the consistency of

  attribute values and element content against other attribute
  values or element content within any other components in the same
  block.
Block and Component Consistency Checks

Block and Component Consistency Checks consist of:

o checking that the combination of blocks and/or components present

  in the IOTP Message are consistent with the rules contained within
  this IOTP specification

o checking for consistency between attributes and element content

  within the blocks within the same IOTP message.

o checking for consistency between attributes and elements in blocks

  in this IOTP message and blocks received in earlier IOTP messages
  for the same IOTP transaction

If the block passes the "Block Level Attribute and Element Checks" and the "Block and Component Consistency Checks" then it is processed either by the IOTP Aware application or perhaps by some "back-end" system such as a payment server.

Transient Technical Errors

During the processing of the Block some temporary failure may occur that can potentially be recovered by the other trading role re- transmitting, at some slightly later time, the original message that they sent. In this case the other role is informed of the Transient

Error by sending them an Error Component (see section 7.21) with the Severity Attribute set to TransientError and the MinRetrySecs attribute set to some value suitable for the Transport Mechanism and/or payment protocol being used (see appropriate Transport and payment protocol Supplements).

Note that transient technical errors can be generated by any of the Trading Roles involved in transaction.

Block Level Business Errors

If a business error occurs in a process such as a Payment or a Delivery, then the appropriate type of response block is returned containing a Status Component (see section 7.16) with the ProcessState attribute set to Failed and the CompletionCode indicating the nature of the problem.

Some business errors may be "transient" in that the Consumer role may be able to recover and complete the transaction in some other way. For example if the Credit Card that a consumer provided had insufficient funds for a purchase, then the Consumer may recover by using a different credit card.

Recovery from "transient" business errors is dependent on the CompletionCode. See the definition of the Status Component for what is possible.

Note that no Error Component or Error Block is generated for business errors.

Idempotency, Processing Sequence, and Message Flow

IOTP messages are actually a combination of blocks and components as described in 3.1.1 IOTP Message Structure. Especially in future extensions of IOTP, a rich variety of combinations of such blocks and components can occur. It is important that the multiple transmission/receipt of the "same" request for an action that will change state does not result in that action occurring more than once. This is called idempotency. For example, a customer paying for an order would want to pay the full amount only once. Most network transport mechanisms have some probability of delivering a message more than once or not at all, perhaps requiring retransmission. On the other hand, a request for status can reasonably be repeated and should be processed fresh each time it is received.

Correct implementation of IOTP can be modelled by a particular processing order as detailed below. Any other method that is indistinguishable in the messages sent between the parties is equally acceptable.

Server Role Processing Sequence

"Server roles" are any Trading Role which is not the Consumer role. They are "Server roles" since they typically receive a request which they must service and then produce a response. However server roles can also initiate transactions. More specifically Server Roles must be able to:

o Initiate a transaction (see section 4.5.1). These are divided

  into:
  -  payment related transactions and
  -  infrastructure transactions

o Accept and process a message received from another role (see

  section 4.5.2). This includes:
  -  identifying if the message belongs to a transaction that has
     been received before
  -  handling duplicate messages
  -  generating Transient errors if the servers that process the
     input message are too busy to handle it
  -  processing the message if it is error free, authorised and, if
     appropriate, producing a response to send back to the other
     role

o Cancel a current transaction if requested (see section 4.5.3)

o Re-transmit messages if a response was expected but has not been

  received in a reasonable time (see section 4.5.4).

Initiating Transactions

Server Roles may initiate a variety of different types of transaction. Specifically:

o an Inquiry Transaction (see section 9.2.1)

o a Ping Transaction (see section 9.2.2)

o an Authentication Transaction (see section 9.1.6)

o a Payment Related Transaction such as:

  -  a Deposit (see section 9.1.7)
  -  a Purchase (see section 9.1.8)
  -  a Refund (see section 9.1.9)
  -  a Withdrawal (see section 9.1.10)
  -  a Value Exchange (see section 9.1.11)

Processing Input Messages

Processing input messages involves the following:

o checking the structure and identity of the message

o checking for and handling duplicate messages

o processing non-duplicate original messages which includes:

  -  checking for errors, then if no errors are found
  -  processing the message to produce an output message if
     appropriate

Each of these is discussed in more detail below.

Checking Structure and Message Identity

It is critical to check that the message is "well formed" XML and that the transaction identifier (IotpTransId attribute on the TransId Component) within the IOTP message can be successfully identified since an IotpTransId will be needed to generate a response.

If the input message is not well formed then generate an Error Component with a Severity of HardError and ErrorCode of XmlNotWellFrmd.

If the message is well formed but the IotpTransId cannot be identified then generate an ErrorComponent with:

o a Severity of HardError and an ErrorCode of AttMissing,

o a PackagedContent containing "IotpTransId" - the missing

  attribute.

Insert the Error Component inside an Error Block with a new TransactionId component with a new IotpTransId and return it to the sender of the original message.

Checking/Handling Duplicate Messages

If the input message can be identified as potentially a valid input message then check to see if an "identical" input message has been received before. Identical means that all blocks, components, elements, attribute values and element content in the input message are the same.

Note: The recommended way of checking for identical messages is to check for equal values of their [DOM-HASH]

If an identical message has been received before then check to see if the processing of the previous message has completed.

If processing has not completed then generate an Error Component with a Severity of Transient Error and an Error Code of MsgBeingProc to indicate the message is being processed and send it back to the sender of the Input Message requesting that the original message be resent after an appropriate period of time.

Otherwise, if processing has completed and resulted in an output message then retrieve the last message that was sent and send it again.

If the message is not a duplicate then it should be processed.

Processing Non-Duplicate Message

Once it's been established that the message is not a duplicate, then it can be processed. This involves:

o checking that a server is available to handle the message,

  generating a Transient Error if it is not

o checking the Transaction is Not Already in error or cancelled

o validating the input message. This includes:

  -  checking for message level errors
  -  checking for block level errors
  -  checking any encapsulated data

o checking for errors in the sequence that blocks have been received

o generating error components for any errors that result

o if neither hard errors nor transient errors result, then

  processing the message and generating an output message, if
  required, for return to the sender of the Input Message

Note: This approach to handling of duplicate input messages means, if absolutely "identical" messages are received then absolutely "identical" messages are returned. This also applies to Inquiry and Ping transactions when in reality the state of a transaction or the processing ability of the servers may have changed. If up-to-date status of transactions or servers is required, then an IOTP transaction with a new value for the ID attribute of the MsgId component must be used.

Each of the above steps is discussed below.

CHECKING A SERVER IS AVAILABLE

The process that is handling the input message should check that the rest of the system is not so busy that a response in a reasonable time cannot be produced.

If the server is too busy, then it should generate an Error Component with a Severity of Transient Error and an Error Code of SystemBusy and send it back to the sender of the Input Message requesting that the original message be resent after an appropriate period of time.

Note: Some servers may occasionally become very busy due to unexpected increases in workload. This approach allows short peaks in workloads to be handled by delaying the input of messages by asking the sender of the message to resubmit later.

CHECKING THE TRANSACTION IS NOT ALREADY IN ERROR OR CANCELLED

Check that:

o previous messages received or sent did not contain or result in

  Hard Errors, and

o the Transaction has not been cancelled by either the Consumer or

  the Server Trading Role

If it has then, ignore the message. A transaction with hard errors or that has been cancelled, cannot be restarted.

CHECK FOR MESSAGE AND BLOCK LEVEL ERRORS

If the transaction is still OK then check for message level errors. This involves:

o checking the XML is valid

o checking that the elements, attributes and content of the

  Transaction Reference Block are without error and conform to this
  specification

o checking the digital signature which involves:

  -  checking that the Signature value is correctly calculated, and
  -  the hash values in the digests are correctly calculated where
     the source of the hash value is available.

Checking for block level errors involves:

o checking within each block (apart from the Transaction Reference

  Block) that:
  -  the attributes, elements and element contents are valid
  -  the values of the attributes, elements and element contents are
     consistent within the block

o checking that the combination of blocks are valid

o checking that the values of the attribute, elements and element

  contents are consistent between the blocks in the input message
  and blocks in earlier messages either sent or received. This
  includes checking that the presence of a block is valid for a
  particular transaction type

If the message contains any encapsulated data, then if possible check the encapsulated data for errors using additional software to check the data where appropriate.

Check for Errors in Block Sequence

Note: For reasons of brevity, the following explanations of how to check for errors in Block sequence, the phrase "refers to an IOTP transaction" is interpreted as "is contained in an IOTP Message where

the Trans Ref Block contains an IotpTransId that refers to". So, for example, " If an Error or Cancel Block refers to an IOTP transaction that is not recognised then ..." should be interpreted as " If an Error or Cancel Block is contained in an IOTP Message where the Trans Ref Block contains an IotpTransId that refers to an IOTP transaction that is not recognised then ...

Errors in the sequence that blocks arrive depends on the block. Blocks where checking for sequence is required are:

o Error and Cancel Blocks. If an Error or Cancel Block refers to an

  IOTP transaction that is not recognised then it is a Hard Error.
  Do not return an error if Error or Cancel Blocks have been
  received for the IOTP Transaction before to avoid looping.

o Inquiry Request and Response Blocks. If an Inquiry Request or an

  Inquiry Response Block refers to an IOTP transaction that is not
  recognised then it is a Hard Error

o Authentication Request Block. If an Authentication Request Block

  refers to an IOTP transaction that is recognised it is a Hard
  Error

o Authentication Response Block. Check as follows:

  -  if an Authentication Response Block does not refer to an IOTP
     transaction that is recognised it is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if the Authentication Response Block doesn't refer to an
     Authentication Request that had been previously sent then it is
     a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if an Authentication Response for the same IOTP transaction has
     been received before and the Authentication was successful then
     it is a Hard Error.

o Authentication Status Block. Check as follows:

  -  if an Authentication Status Block does not refer to an IOTP
     transaction that is recognised it is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if the Authentication Status Block doesn't refer to an
     Authentication Response that had been previously sent then it
     is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if an Authentication Status for the same IOTP transaction has
     been received before then it is a Warning Error

o TPO Selection Block (Merchant only). Check as follows:

  -  if the TPO Selection Block doesn't refer to an IOTP Transaction
     that is recognised then it is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if the TPO Selection Block refers to an IOTP Transaction where
     a TPO Block and Offer Response (in one message) had previously
     been sent then it is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if the TPO Selection Block does not refer to an IOTP
     Transaction where a TPO Block only (i.e. without an Offer
     Response) had previously been sent then it is a Hard Error,
     otherwise
  -  if a TPO Selection Block for the same TPO Block has been
     received before then it is a Hard Error

o Payment Request Block (Payment Handler only). Check as follows:

  -  if the Payment Request Block refers to an IOTP Transaction that
     is not recognised then its OK, otherwise
  -  if the Payment Request Block refers to IOTP Transaction that
     was not for a Payment then it is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if there was a previous payment that failed with a non-
     recoverable Completion Code then it is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if a previous payment is still in progress then it is a Hard
     Error

o Payment Exchange Block (Payment Handler only). Check as follows:

  -  if the Payment Exchange Block doesn't refer to an IOTP
     Transaction that is recognised then it is a Hard Error,
     otherwise
  -  if the Payment Exchange doesn't refer to an IOTP Transaction
     where a Payment Exchange had previously been sent then it a
     Hard Error

o Delivery Request (Delivery Handler Only). If the Delivery Request

  Block refers to an IOTP Transaction that is recognised by the
  Server then it is a Hard Error

If any Error Components have been generated then collect them into an Error Block for sending to the sender of the Input message. Note that Error Blocks should be sent back to the sender of the message and to the ErrorLogNetLocn for the Trading Role of the sender if one is specified.

Note: The above checking on the sequence of Authentication Responses and Payment Requests supports the Consumer re-submitting a repeat action request since the previous one failed, for example:

o because they did not know the correct response (e.g., a password)

  on an authentication or,

o they were unable to pay as there were insufficient funds on a

  credit card

PROCESS THE ERROR FREE INPUT MESSAGE

If the input message passes the previous checks then it can be processed to produce an output message if required. Note that:

o Inquiry Requests on Ping Transactions should be ignored

o if the Input message contains an Error Block with a Transient

  Error then wait for the required time then resend the previous
  message, if a response to the earlier message has not been
  received

o if the input message contains a Error Component with a HardError

  or a Cancel Block then stop all further processing of the
  transaction. This includes suppressing the sending of any messages
  currently being generated or responding to any new non-duplicate
  messages that are received

o processing of encapsulated messages (e.g., Payment Protocol

  Messages) may result in additional transient errors

o a digital signature can only safely be generated once all the

  blocks and components have been generated and it is known which
  elements in the message need to be signed.

If an output message is generated then it should be saved so that it can be resent as required if an identical input message is received again. Note that output messages that contain transient errors are not saved so that they can be processed afresh when the input message is received again.

Cancelling a Transaction

This process is used to cancel a transaction running on an IOTP server. It is initiated by some other process as a result of an external request from another system or server that is being run by the same Trading Role. The processing required is as follows:

o if the IotpTransId of the transaction to be cancelled is not

  recognised, or complete then fail the request, otherwise

o if the IotpTransId refers to a Ping Transaction then fail the

  request, otherwise

o determine which Document Exchange to cancel and generate a Cancel

  Block and send it to the other party

Note: Cancelling a transaction on an IOTP server typically arises for a business reason. For example a merchant may have attempted authentication several times without success and as a result decides to cancel the transaction. Therefore the process that decides to take this action needs to send a message from the process/server that made the business decision to the IOTP server with the instruction that the IOTP transaction should be cancelled.

Retransmitting Messages

The server should periodically check for transactions where a message is expected in return but none has been received after a time that is dependent on factors such as:

o the Transport Mechanism being used;

o the time required to process encapsulated messages (e.g., Payment

  messages) and

o whether or not human input is required.

If no message has been received the original message should be resent. This should occur up to a maximum number of times dependent on the reliability of the Transport Mechanism being used.

If no response is received after the required time then the Transaction should be "timed out". In this case, set the process state of the transaction to Failed, and a completion code of either:

o TimedOutRcvr if the transaction can potentially recovered later,

  or

o TimedOutNoRcvr if the transaction is non-recoverable

Client Role Processing Sequence

The "Client role" in IOTP is the Consumer Trading Role.

Note: A company or Organisation that is a Merchant, for example, may take on the Trading Role of a Consumer when making purchases or downloading or withdrawing electronic cash.

More specifically the Consumer Role must be able to:

o Initiate a transaction (see section 4.6.1). These are divided

  into:
  -  payment related transactions and
  -  infrastructure transactions

o Accept and process a message received from another role (see

  section 4.6.2). This includes:
  -  identifying if the message belongs to a transaction that has
     been received before
  -  handling duplicate messages
  -  generating Transient errors if the servers that process the
     input message are too busy to handle it
  -  processing the message if it is error free and, if appropriate,
     producing a response to send back to the other role

o Cancel a current transaction if requested, for example by the User

  (see section 4.6.3)

o Re-transmit messages if a response was expected but has not been

  received in a reasonable time (see section 4.6.4).

Initiating Transactions

The Consumer Role may initiate a number of different types of transaction. Specifically:

o an Inquiry Transaction (see section 9.2.1)

o a Ping Transaction (see section 9.2.2)

o an Authentication Transaction (see section 9.1.6)

Processing Input Messages

Processing of Input Messages for a Consumer Role is the same as for an IOTP Server (see section 4.5.2) except in the area of checking for Errors in Block Sequence (for an IOTP Server see section 4.5.2.4). This is described below

Note: The description of the processing for an IOTP Server includes consideration of multi-threading of input messages and multi-tasking of requests. For the Consumer Role - particularly if running on a stand-alone system such as a PC - use of multi-threading is a decision of the implementer of the consumer role IOTP solution.

Check for Errors in Block Sequence

The handling of the following blocks is the same as for an IOTP Server (see section 4.5.2.4) except that the Consumer Role is substituted for IOTP Server Role:

o Error and Cancel Blocks,

o Inquiry Request and Response Blocks,

o Authentication Request, Response and Status Blocks.

For the other blocks a Consumer role might receive, the potential errors in the sequence that blocks arrive depends on the block. Blocks where checking for sequence is required are:

o TPO Block. Check as follows:

  -  if the input message also contains an Authentication Request
     block and an Offer Response Block then there is a Hard Error,
     otherwise
  -  if the input message also contains an Authentication Request
     block and Authentication Status block then there is Hard Error
     otherwise,
  -  if the input message also contains an Authentication Request
     block and the IOTP Transaction is recognised by the Consumer
     role's system, then there is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if the input message also contains an Authentication Status
     block and the IOTP Transaction is not recognised by the
     Consumer role's system then there is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if input message also contains an Authentication Status Block
     and the Authentication Status Block has not been sent after an
     earlier Authentication Response message then there is a hard
     error
  -  if input message also contains an Offer Response Block and the
     IOTP Transaction is recognised by the Consumer role's system
     then there is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if the TPO Block occurs on its own and the IOTP Transaction is
     recognised by the Consumer role's system then there is a Hard
     Error

o Offer Response Block. Check as follows:

  -  if the Offer Response Block is part of a Brand Independent
     Offer Exchange (see section 9.1.2.2) then there is no sequence
     checking as it is part of the first message received, otherwise
  -  if the Offer Response Block is not part of an IOTP Transaction
     that is recognised by the Consumer role then there is a Hard
     Error, otherwise
  -  if the Offer Response Block does not refer to an IOTP
     transaction where a TPO Selection Block was the last message
     sent then there is a Hard Error

o Payment Exchange Block. Check as follows:

  -  if the Payment Exchange Block doesn't refer to an IOTP
     Transaction that is recognised by the Consumer role's system
     then there is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if the Payment Exchange doesn't refer to an IOTP Transaction
     where either a Payment Request or a Payment Exchange block was
     most recently sent then there is a Hard Error

o Payment Response Block. Check as follows:

  -  if the Payment Response Block doesn't refer to an IOTP
     Transaction that is recognised by the Consumer role's system
     then there is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  if the Payment Response doesn't refer to an IOTOP Transaction
     where either a Payment Request or a Payment Exchange block was
     most recently sent then there is a Hard Error

o Delivery Response Block. Check as follows:

  -  if the Delivery Response Block doesn't refer to an IOTP
     Transaction that is recognised by the Consumer role's system
     then there is a Hard Error, otherwise
  -  If the Delivery Response doesn't refer to an IOTP Transaction
     where either a Payment Request or a Payment Exchange block was
     most recently sent then there is a Hard Error

Cancelling a Transaction

This process cancels a current transaction on an Consumer role's system as a result of an external request from the user, or another system or server in the Consumer's role. The processing is the same as for an IOTP Server (see section 4.5.3).

Retransmitting Messages

The process of retransmitting messages is the same as for an IOTP Server (see section 4.5.4).

Security Considerations

This section considers, from an IETF perspective how IOTP addresses security. The next section (see section 6. Digital Signatures and IOTP) describes how IOTP uses Digital Signatures when these are needed.

This section covers:

o determining whether to use digital signatures

o data privacy, and

o payment protocol security.

Determining whether to use digital signatures

The use of digital signatures within IOTP are entirely optional. IOTP can work successfully entirely without the use of digital signatures.

Ultimately it is up to the Merchant, or other trading role, to decide whether IOTP Messages will include signatures, and for the Consumer

to decide whether carrying out a transaction without signatures is an acceptable risk. If Merchants discover that transactions without signatures are not being accepted, then they will either:

o start using signatures,

o find a method of working which does not need signatures, or

o accept a lower volume and value of business.

A non-exhaustive list of the reasons why digital signatures might be used follows:

o the Merchant (or other trading role) wants to demonstrate that

  they can be trusted. If, for example, a merchant generates an
  Offer Response Signature (see section 7.19.2) using a certificate
  from a trusted third party, known to the Consumer, then the
  Consumer can check the signature and certificate and so more
  reasonably rely on the offer being from the actual Organisation
  the Merchant claims to be. In this case signatures using
  asymmetric cryptography are likely to be required

o the Merchant, or other Trading Role, want to generate a record of

  the transaction that is fit for a particular purpose. For example,
  with appropriate trust hierarchies, digital signatures could be
  checked by the Consumer to determine:
  -  if it would be accepted by tax authorities as a valid record of
     a transaction, or
  -  if some warranty, for example from a "Better Business Bureau"
     orsimilar was being provided

o the Payment Handler, or Delivery Handler, needs to know that the

  request is unaltered and authorised. For example, in IOTP, details
  of how much to pay is sent to the Consumer in the Offer Response
  and then forwarded to the Payment Handler in a Payment Request. If
  the request is not signed, the Consumer could change the amount
  due by, for example, removing a digit. If the Payment Handler has
  no access to the original payment information in the Offer
  Response, then, without signatures, the Payment Handler cannot be
  sure that the data has not been altered. Similarly, if the payment
  information is not digitally signed, the Payment Handler cannot be
  sure who is the Merchant that is requesting the payment

o a Payment Handler or Delivery Handler wants to provide a non-

  refutable record of the completion status of a Payment or
  Delivery. If a Payment Response or Delivery Response is signed,
  then the Consumer can later use the record of the Payment or
  Delivery to prove that it occurred.  This could be used, for
  example, for customer care purposes.

A non-exhaustive list of the reasons why digital signatures might not be used follows:

o trading roles are combined therefore changes to data made by the

  consumer can be detected. One of the reasons for using signatures
  is so that one trading role can determine if data has been changed
  by the Consumer or some other party. However if the trading roles
  have access to the necessary data, then it might be possible to
  compare, for example, the payment information in the Payment
  Request with the payment information in the Offer Response. Access
  to the data necessary could be realised by, for example, the
  Merchant and Payment Handler roles being carried out by the same
  Organisation on the same system, or the Merchant and Payment
  Handler roles being carried out on different systems but the
  systems can communicate in some way. (Note this type of
  communication is outside the current scope of IOTP)

o the processing cost of the cryptography is too high. For example,

  if a payment is being made of only a few cents, the cost of
  carrying out all the cryptography associated with generating and
  checking digital signatures might make the whole transaction
  uneconomic. Co-locating trading roles, could help avoid this
  problem.

Symmetric and Asymmetric Cryptography

The advantage of using symmetric keys with IOTP is that no Public Key Infrastructure need be set up and just the Merchant, Payment Handler and Delivery Handler need to agree on the shared secrets to use.

However the disadvantage of symmetric cryptography is that the Consumer cannot easily check the credentials of the Merchant, Payment Handler, etc. that they are dealing with. This is likely to reduce, somewhat, the trust that the Consumer will have carrying out the transaction.

However it should be noted that even if asymmetric cryptography is being used, the Consumer does not NEED to be provided with any digital certificates as the integrity of the transaction is determined by, for example, the Payment Handler checking the Offer Response Signature copied to the Payment Request.

Note that symmetric, asymmetric or both types of cryptography may be used in a single transaction.

Data Privacy

Privacy of information is provided by sending IOTP Messages between the various Trading Roles using a secure channel such as [SSL/TLS]. Use of a secure channel within IOTP is optional.

Payment Protocol Security

IOTP is designed to be completely blind to the payment protocol being used to effect a payment. From the security perspective, this means that IOTP neither helps, nor hinders, the achievement of payment security.

If it is necessary to consider payment security from an IOTP perspective, then this should be included in the payment protocol supplement which describes how IOTP supports that payment protocol.

However what IOTP is designed to do is to use digital signatures to bind together the record, contained in a "response" message, of each trading exchange in a transaction. For example IOTP can bind together: an Offer, a Payment and a Delivery.

Digital Signatures and IOTP

IOTP can work successfully without using any digital signatures although in an open networking environment it will be less secure - see 5. Security Considerations for a description of the factors that need to be considered.

However, this section describes how to use digital signatures in the many situations when they will be needed. Topics covered are:

o an overview of how IOTP uses digital signatures

o how to check a signature is correctly calculated

o how Payment Handlers and Delivery Handlers check they can carry

  out payments or deliveries on behalf of a Merchant.

How IOTP uses Digital Signatures

In general, signatures when used with IOTP:

o are always treated as IOTP Components (see section 7)

o contain digests of one or more IOTP Components or Trading Blocks,

  possibly including other Signature Components, in any IOTP message
  within the same IOTP Transaction

o identify:

  -  which Organisation signed (originated) the signature, and
  -  which Organisation(s) should process the signature in order to
     check that the Action the Organisation should take can occur.

Digital certificates may be associated with digital signatures if asymmetric cryptography is being used. However if symmetric cryptography is being used, then the digital certificate will be replaced by some identifier of the secret key to use.

The way in which Signatures Components digest one or more elements is illustrated in the figure below.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
IOTP MESSAGE                                  SIGNATURE COMPONENT
IOTP Message                                   Signature Id = P1.3
 |-Trans Ref Block        digest TransRefBlk   |-Manifest
 |  |      ID=P1.1-----------------------------|->|-Digest of P1.1--
 |  |-Trans Id Comp       digest TransIdComp   |  |                 |
 |  |     ID = M1.2----------------------------|->|-Digest of M1.2--|
 |  |-Msg Id Comp.           digest Signature  |  |                 |
 |  |      ID = P1          -------------------|->|-Digest of M1.5--|
 |                         |   digest element  |  |                 |
 |-Signatures Block        |  -----------------|->|-Digest of M1.7--|
 |  |       ID=P1.2        | |  digest element |  |                 |
 |  |-Signature ID=P1.3    | |  ---------------|->|-Digest of C1.4--|
 |  |-Signature ID=M1.5----  | |               |  |                 |
 |  |-Signature ID=P1.4      | | Points to     |   -RecipientInfo*  |
 |  |-Certificate ID=M1.6<---|-|---------------|------CertRef=M1.6  |
 |  |                        | | Certs to use  |  Sig.ValueRef=P1.4 |
 |  |                        | |               |        |           |
 |  |                        | |               |        |           |
 |-Trading Block. ID=P1.5    | |               |        v           |
 |  |-Comp. ID=M1.7----------  |                -Value* ID=P1.4:    |
 |  |                          |                   JtvwpMdmSfMbhK<--
 |  |-Comp. ID=P1.6            |                   r1Ln3vovbMQttbBI
 |  |                          |                   J8pxLjoSRfe1o6k
 |  |-Comp. ID=C1.4------------                    OGG7nTFzTi+/0<-
 |  |-Comp. ID=C1.5
                         Digital signature of Manifest element
                         using certificate identified by CertRef

Elements that are digested can be in any IOTP Message

    within the same IOTP Transaction
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                     Figure 10 Signature Digests

Note: The classic example of one signature signing another in IOTP, is when an Offer is first signed by a Merchant creating an "Offer Response" signature, which is then later signed by a Payment Handler together with a record of the payment creating a "Payment Receipt" signature. In this way, the payment in an IOTP Transaction is bound to the Merchant's offer.

Note that one Manifest may be associated with multiple signature "Value" elements where each Value element contains a digital signature over the same Manifest, perhaps using the same (or different) signature algorithm but using a different certificate or shared secret key. Specifically it will allow the Merchant to agree on different shared secrets keys with their Payment Handler and Delivery Handler.

The detailed definitions of a Signature component are contained in section 7.19.

The remainder of this section contains:

o an example of how IOTP uses signatures

o how the OriginatorInfo and RecipientInfo elements within a

  Signature Component are used to identify the Organisations
  associated with the signature

o how IOTP uses signatures to prove actions complete successfully

IOTP Signature Example

An example of how signatures are used is illustrated in the figure below which shows how the various components and elements in a Baseline Purchase relate to one another. Refer to this example in the later description of how signatures are used to check a payment or delivery can occur (see section 6.3).

Note: A Baseline Purchase transaction has been used for illustration purposes. The usage of the elements and attributes is the same for all types of IOTP Transactions.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

TPO SELECTION BLOCK TPO BLOCK IOTPSIGNATURE BLOCK

                                             | (Offer Response)
Brand Selection             Organisation<---    |------Signature

Component Component | | Component

  |                       |              |           -Manifest
  |BrandList               -Trading Role |            |
  |  Ref                     Element     | Originator |-Orig.
  v                         (Merchant)    ------------|--Info
Brand List                                    Ref     |
 >Component                                              |
| |-Protocol       ------>  Organisation     Recipient   |-Recipient
| | Amount Elem   |         Component <------------------|--Info
| |   |           |          |                 Refs      |
| |Pay|Protocol   |Action     -Trading Role              |
| |   | Ref       |OrgRef       Element                  |
| |   v           |          (Payment Handler)           |
|  -PayProtocol--                                        |
|    Elem                  ->Organisation    Recipient   |-Recipient
|                         |  Component <--------------------Info
|                         |  |                 Refs
|                         |   -Trading Role
|                         |     Element
|                         | (Delivery Handler
|
|           OFFER RESPONSE BLOCK
|                         |
|BrandListRef             |ActionOrgRef
|                         |
 --Payment                 ---Delivery

Component Component

The Manifest element in the Signature Component contains digests of: the Trans Ref Block (not shown); the Transaction ID Component (not shown); Organisation Components (Merchant, Payment Handler, Delivery Handler); the Brand List Component; the Order Component, the Payment Component the Delivery Component and the Brand Selection Component (if a Brand Dependent Purchase).

  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
     Figure 11 Example use of Signatures for Baseline Purchase

OriginatorInfo and RecipientInfo Elements

The OriginatorRef attribute of the OriginatorInfo element in the Signature Component contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5) that points to the Organisation Component of the Organisation which generated the Signature. In this example its the Merchant.

Note that the value of the content of the Attribute element with a Type attribute set to IOTP Signature Type must match the Trading Role of the Organisation which signed it. If it does not, then it is an error. Valid combinations are given in the table below.

     IOTP Signature Type    Valid Trading Role
     OfferResponse           Merchant
     PaymentResponse         PaymentHandler
     DeliveryResponse        DeliveryHandler
     AuthenticationRequest   any role
     AuthenticationResponse  any role
     PingRequest             any role
     PingResponse            any role

The RecipientRefs attribute of the RecipientInfo element in the Signature Component contains Element References to the Organisation Components of the Organisations that should use the signature to verify that:

o they have a pre-existing relationship with the Organisation that

  generated the signature,

o the data which is secured by the signature has not been changed,

o the data has been signed correctly, and

o the action they are required to undertake on behalf of the

  Merchant is therefore authorised.

Note that if symmetric cryptography is being used then a separate RecipientInfo and Value elements for each different set of shared secret keys are likely within the Signature Component.

Alternatively if asymmetric cryptography is being used then the RecpientRefs attribute of one RecipientInfo element may refer to multiple Organisation Components if they are all using the same certificates.

Using signatures to Prove Actions Complete Successfully

Proving an action completed successfully, is achieved by signing data on Response messages. Specifically:

o on the Offer Response, when a Merchant is making an Offer to the

  Consumer which can then be sent to either:
  -  a Payment Handler to prove that the Merchant authorises
     Payment, or
  -  a Delivery Handler to prove that Merchant authorises Delivery,
     provided other necessary authorisations are complete (see
     below)

o on the Payment Response, when a Payment Handler is generating a

  Payment Receipt which can be sent to either:
  -  a Delivery Handler, in a Delivery Request Block to authorise
     Delivery together with the Offer Response signature, or
  -  another Payment Handler, in a second Payment Request, to
     authorise the second payment in a Value Exchange IOTP
     Transaction

o Delivery Response, when a Delivery Handler is generating a

  Delivery Note. This can be used to prove after the event what the
  Delivery Handler said they would do

o Authentication Response. One method of authenticating another

  party to a trade is to send an Authentication Request specifying
  that a Digital Signature should be used for authentication

o Transaction Status Inquiry. The Inquiry Response Block may be

  digitally signed to attest to the authenticity of the response

o Ping. The Ping Response may be digitally signed so that checks can

  be made that the signature can be understood.

This proof of an action may, in future versions of IOTP, also be used to prove after the event that the IOTP transaction occurred. For example to a Customer Care Provider.

Checking a Signature is Correctly Calculated

Checking a signature is correctly calculated is part of checking for Message Level Errors (see section 4.3.2). It is included here so that all signature and security related considerations are kept together.

Before a Trading Role can check a signature it must identify which of the potentially multiple Signature elements should be checked. The steps involved are as follows:

o check that a Signature Block is present and it contains one or

  more Signature Components

o identify the Organisation Component which contains an OrgId

  attribute for the Organisation which is carrying out the signature
  check. If no or more than one Organisation Component is found then
  it is an error

o use the ID attribute of the Organisation Component to find the

  RecipientInfo element that contains a RecipientRefs attribute that
  refers to that Organisation Component. Note there may be no
  signatures to verify

o check the Signature Component that contains the identified

  RecipientInfo element as follows:
  -  use the SignatureValueRef and the SignatureAlgorithmRef
     attributes to identify, respectively: the Value element that
     contains the signature to be checked and the Signature
     Algorithm element that describes the signature algorithm to be
     used to verify the Signature, then
  -  if the Signature Algorithm element indicates that asymmetric
     cryptography is being used then use the SignatureCertRef to
     identify the Certificate to be used by the signature algorithm
  -  if Signature Algorithm element indicates that symmetric
     cryptography is being used then the content of the
     RecipientInfo element is used to identify the correct shared
     secret key to use
  -  use the specified signature algorithm to check that the Value
     Element correctly signs the Manifest Element
  -  check that the Digest Elements in the Manifest Element are
     correctly calculated where Components or Blocks referenced by
     the Digest have been received by the Organisation checking the
     signature.

Checking a Payment or Delivery can occur

This section describes the processes required for a Payment Handler or Delivery Handler to check that a payment or delivery can occur. This may include checking signatures if this is specified by the Merchant.

In outline the steps are:

o check that the Payment Request or Delivery Request has been sent

  to the correct Organisation

o check that correct IOTP components are present in the request, and

o check that the payment or delivery is authorised

For clarity and brevity the following terms or phrases are used in this section:

o a "Request Block" is used to refer to either a Payment Request

  Block (see section 8.7) or a Delivery Request Block (see section
  8.10) unless specified to the contrary

o a "Response Block" is used to refer to either a Payment Response

  Block (see section 8.9) or a Delivery Response Block (see section
  8.11)

o an "Action" is used to refer to an action which occurs on receipt

  of a Request Block. Actions can be either a Payment or a Delivery

o an "Action Organisation", is used to refer to the Payment Handler

  or Delivery Handler that carries out an Action

o a "Signer of an Action", is used to refer to the Organisations

  that sign data about an Action to authorise the Action, either in
  whole or in part

o a "Verifier of an Action", is used to refer to the Organisations

  that verify data to determine if they are authorised to carry out
  the Action

o an ActionOrgRef attribute contains Element References which can be

  used to identify the "Action Organisation" that should carry out
  an Action

Check Request Block sent Correct Organisation

Checking the Request Block was sent to the correct Organisation varies depending on whether the request refers to a Payment or a Delivery.

Payment

In outline a Payment Handler checks if it can accept or make a payment by identifying the Payment Component in the Payment Request Block it has received, then using the ID of the Payment Component to track through the Brand List and Brand Selection Components to identify the Organisation selected by the Consumer and then checking that this Organisation is itself.

The way data is accessed to do this is illustrated in the figure below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
                                                 Start
                                                  |
                                                  v

Brand List<--------------------------+-----------Payment Component BrandListRef | Component

|                                   |
|-Brand<--------------------------  |
| Element        BrandRef         | |
|  |                          Brand Selection
|  |Protocol                     Component
|  | AmountRefs                   | |
|  v                  Protocol    | |
|-Protocol Amount<----------------  |
| Element----------  AmountRef      |
|  |               |                |
|  |Currency       |Pay             |
|  | AmountRefs    |Protocol        |
|  v               |Ref             |
|-Currency Amount  |                |
| Element<---------|----------------
|                  |
 -PayProtocol<-----
  Element---------------------->Organisation
                 Action         Component
                 OrgRef          |
                                  -Trading Role
                                    Element
                                 (Payment Handler)
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
  Figure 12 Checking a Payment Handler can carry out a Payment

The following describes the steps involved and the checks which need to be made:

o Identify the Payment Component (see section 7.9) in the Payment

  Request Block that was received.

o Identify the Brand List and Brand Selection Components for the

  Payment Component. This involves:
  -  identifying the Brand List Component (see section 7.7) where
     the value of its ID attribute matches the BrandListRef
     attribute of the Payment Component. If no or more than one
     Brand List Component is found there is an error.
  -  identifying the Brand Selection Component (see section 7.8)
     where the value of its BrandListRef attribute matches the
     BrandListRef of the Payment Component. If no or more than one
     matching Brand Selection Component is found there is an error.

o Identify the Brand, Protocol Amount, Pay Protocol and Currency

  Amount elements within the Brand List that have been selected by
  the Consumer as follows:
  -  the Brand Element (see section 7.7.1) selected is the element
     where the value of its Id attribute matches the value of the
     BrandRef attribute in the Brand Selection. If no or more than
     one matching Brand Element is found then there is an error.
  -  the Protocol Amount Element (see section 7.7.3) selected is the
     element where the value of its Id attribute matches the value
     of the ProtocolAmountRef attribute in the Brand Selection
     Component. If no or more than one matching Protocol Amount
     Element is found there is an error
  -  the Pay Protocol Element (see section 7.7.5) selected is the
     element where the value of its Id attribute matches the value
     of the PayProtocolRef attribute in the identified Protocol
     Amount Element.  If no or more than one matching Pay Protocol
     Element is found there is an error
  -  the Currency Amount Element (see section 7.7.4) selected is the
     element where the value of its Id attribute matches the value
     of the CurrencyAmountRef attribute in the Brand Selection
     Component. If no or more than one matching Currency Amount
     element is found there is an error

o Check the consistency of the references in the Brand List and

  Brand Selection Components:
  -  check that an Element Reference exists in the
     ProtocolAmountRefs attribute of the identified Brand Element
     that matches the Id attribute of the identified Protocol Amount
     Element. If no or more than one matching Element Reference can
     be found there is an error
  -  check that the CurrencyAmountRefs attribute of the identified
     Protocol Amount element contains an element reference that
     matches the Id attribute of the identified Currency Amount
     element. If no or more than one matching Element Reference is
     found there is an error.
  -  check the consistency of the elements in the Brand List.
     Specifically, the selected Brand, Protocol Amount, Pay Protocol
     and Currency Amount Elements are all child elements of the
     identified Brand List Component. If they are not there is an
     error.

o Check that the Payment Handler that received the Payment Request

  Block is the Payment Handler selected by the Consumer. This
  involves:
  -  identifying the Organisation Component for the Payment Handler.
     This is the Organisation Component where its ID attribute
     matches the ActionOrgRef attribute in the identified Pay
     Protocol Element. If no or more than one matching Organisation
     Component is found there is an error
  -  checking the Organisation Component has a Trading Role Element
     with a Role attribute of PaymentHandler. If not there is an
     error
  -  finally, if the identified Organisation Component is not the
     same as the Organisation that received the Payment Request
     Block, then there is an error.
Delivery

The way data is accessed by a Delivery Handler in order to check that it may carry out a delivery is illustrated in the figure below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
                        Start
                          |
                          v
                       Delivery
                       Component
                          |
                          |ActionOrgRef
                          |
                          v
                       Organisation
                       Component
                       |
                        -Trading Role
                          Element
                       (Delivery Handler)
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
     Figure 13 Checking a Delivery Handler can carry out a Delivery

The steps involved are as follows:

o Identify the Delivery Component in the Delivery Request Block. If

  there is no or more than one matching Delivery Component there is
  an error

o Use the ActionOrgRef attribute of the Delivery Component to

  identify the Organisation Component of the Delivery Handler. If
  there is no or more than one matching Organisation Component there
  is an error

o If the Organisation Component for the Delivery Handler does not

  have a Trading Role Element with a Role attribute of
  DeliveryHandler there is an error

o Finally, if the Organisation that received the Delivery Request

  Block does not identify the Organisation Component for the
  Delivery Handler as itself, then there is an error.

Check Correct Components present in Request Block

Check that the correct components are present in the Payment Request Block (see section 8.7) or in the Delivery Request Block (see section 8.10).

If components are missing, there is an error.

Check an Action is Authorised

The previous steps identified the Action Organisation and that all the necessary components are present. This step checks that the Action Organisation is authorised to carry out the Action.

In outline the Action Organisation will identifies the Merchant, checks that it has a pre-existing agreement with the Merchant that allows it carry out the Action and that any constraints implied by that agreement are being followed, then, if signatures are required, it checks that they sign the correct data.

The steps involved are as follows:

o Identify the Merchant. This is the Organisation Component with a

  Trading Role Element which has a Role attribute with a value of
  Merchant. If no or more than one Trading Role Element is found,
  there is an error

o Check the Action Organisation's agreements with the Merchant

  allows the Action to be carried out. To do this the Action
  Organisation must check that:
  -  the Merchant is known and a pre-existing agreement exists for
     the Action Organisation to be their agent for the payment or
     delivery
  -  they are allowed to take part in the type of IOTP transaction
     that is occurring. For example a Payment Handler may have
     agreed to accept payments as part of a Baseline Purchase, but
     not make payments as part of a Baseline Refund
  -  any constraints in their agreement with the Merchant are being
     followed, for example, whether or not an Offer Response
     signature is required

o Check the signatures are correct. If signatures are required then

  they need to be checked. This involves:
  -  Identifying the correct signatures to check. This involves the
     Action Organisation identifying the Signature Components that
     contain references to the Action Organisation (see 6.3.1).
     Depending on the IOTP Transaction being carried out (see
     section 9) either one or two signatures may be identified
  -  checking that the Signature Components are correct. This
     involves checking that Digest elements exist within the
     Manifest Element that refer to the necessary Trading Components
     (see section 6.3.3.1).
Check the Signatures Digests are correct

All Signature Components contained within IOTP Messages must include Digest elements that refer to:

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP

  message that contains the Signature Component. This binds the
  globally unique IotpTransId to other components which make up the
  IOTP Transaction

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the first

  IOTP Message that contained the signature. This binds the
  IotpTransId with information about the IOTP Message contained
  inside the Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2).

Check that each Signature Component contains Digest elements that refer to the correct data required.

The Digest elements that need to be present depend on the Trading Role of the Organisation which generated (signed) the signature:

o if the signer of the signature is a Merchant then:

  -  Digest elements must be present for all the components in the
     Request Block apart from the Brand Selection Component which is
     optional

o if the signer of the signature is a Payment Handler then Digest

  elements must be present for:
  -  the Signature Component signed by the Merchant, and optionally
  -  one or more Signature Components signed by the previous Payment
     Handler(s) in the Transaction.

Trading Components

This section describes the Trading Components used within IOTP. Trading Components are the child XML elements which occur immediately below a Trading Block as illustrated in the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
         IOTP MESSAGE  <----------- IOTP Message - an XML Document
          |                         which is transported between the
          |                         Trading Roles
          |-Trans Ref Block <-----  Trans Ref Block - contains
          |  |                      information which describes the
          |  |                      IOTP Transaction and the IOTP
                                    Message.
--------> |  |-Trans Id Comp. <---  Transaction Id Component -

| | | uniquely identifies the IOTP | | | Transaction. The Trans Id | | | Components are the same across | | | all IOTP messages that comprise | | | a single IOTP transaction. | | |-Msg Id Comp. <----- Message Id Component - | | identifies and describes an IOTP | | Message within an IOTP | | Transaction | |-Signature Block <----- Signature Block (optional) - | | | contains one or more Signature | | | Components and their associated | | | Certificates | ---> | |-Signature Comp. <-- Signature Component - contains | | | | digital signatures. Signatures | | | | may sign digests of the Trans Ref | | | | Block and any Trading Component | | | | in any IOTP Message in the same | | | | IOTP Transaction. | | | |-Certificate Comp. <- Certificate Component. Used to | | | check the signature.

 Trading  |-Trading Block <-------- Trading Block - an XML Element

Components | |-Trading Comp. within an IOTP Message that | | | |-Trading Comp. contains a predefined set of | ---> | |-Trading Comp. Trading Components | | |-Trading Comp. | | |-Trading Comp. <----- Trading Components - XML | | Elements within a Trading Block | |-Trading Block that contain a predefined set of

--------> |  |-Trading Comp.        XML elements and attributes
          |  |-Trading Comp.        containing information required
          |  |-Trading Comp.        to support a Trading Exchange
          |  |-Trading Comp.
          |  |-Trading Comp.
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                      Figure 14 Trading Components

The Trading Components described in this section are listed below in approximately the sequence they are likely to be used:

o Protocol Options Component

o Authentication Request Component

o Authentication Response Component

o Trading Role Information Request Component

o Order Component

o Organisation Component

o Brand List Component

o Brand Selection Component

o Payment Component

o Payment Scheme Component

o Payment Receipt Component

o Delivery Component

o Delivery Data Component

o Delivery Note Component

o Signature Component

o Certificate Component

o Error Component

Note that the following components are listed in other sections of this specification:

o Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1)

o Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2)

Protocol Options Component

Protocol options are options which apply to the IOTP Transaction as a whole. Essentially it provides a short description of the entire transaction and the net location which the Consumer role should branch to if the IOTP Transaction is successful.

The definition of a Protocol Options Component is as follows.

<!ELEMENT ProtocolOptions EMPTY > <!ATTLIST ProtocolOptions

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ShortDesc          CDATA   #REQUIRED
SenderNetLocn      CDATA   #IMPLIED
SecureSenderNetLocn CDATA  #IMPLIED
SuccessNetLocn     CDATA   #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                    Protocol Options Component within the IOTP
                    Transaction.

Xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child

                    elements within this component, unless
                    overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
                    element. See section 3.8 Identifying Languages.

ShortDesc This contains a short description of the IOTP

                    Transaction in the language defined by xml:lang.
                    Its purpose is to provide an explanation of what
                    type of IOTP Transaction is being conducted by
                    the parties involved.
                    It is used to facilitate selecting an individual
                    transaction from a list of similar transactions,
                    for example from a database of IOTP transactions
                    which has been stored by a Consumer, Merchant,
                    etc.

SenderNetLocn This contains the non secured net location of

                    the sender of the TPO Block in which the
                    Protocol Options Component is contained.
                    It is the net location to which the recipient of
                    the TPO block should send a TPO Selection Block
                    if required.
                    The content of this attribute is dependent on
                    the Transport Mechanism see the Transport
                    Mechanism Supplement.

SecureSenderNetLocn This contains the secured net location of the

                    sender of the TPO Block in which the Protocol
                    Options Component is contained.
                    The content of this attribute is dependent on
                    the Transport Mechanism see the Transport
                    Mechanism Supplement.

SuccessNetLocn This contains the net location that should be

                    displayed after the IOTP Transaction has
                    successfully completed.
                    The content of this attribute is dependent on
                    the Transport Mechanism see the Transport
                    Mechanism Supplement.

Either SenderNetLocn, SecureSenderNetLocn or both must be present.

Authentication Request Component

This Trading Component contains parameter data that is used in an Authentication of one Trading Role by another. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT AuthReq (Algorithm, PackagedContent*)> <!ATTLIST AuthReq

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
AuthenticationId   CDATA   #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

If required the Algorithm may use the challenge data, contained in the Packaged Content elements within the Authentication Request Component in its calculation. The format of the Packaged Contents are Algorithm dependent.

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Authentication Request Component within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

AuthenticationId An identifier specified by the Authenticator

                  which, if returned by the Organisation that
                  receives the Authentication Request, will enable
                  the Authenticator to identify which Authentication
                  is being referred to.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14.Glossary

Content:

PackagedContent This contains the challenge data as one or more

                  Packaged Content (see section 3.7) that is to be
                  responded to using the Algorithm defined by the
                  Algorithm element.

Algorithm This contains information which describes the

                  Algorithm (see 7.19 Signature Components) that
                  must be used to generate the Authentication
                  Response.
                  The Algorithms that may be used are identified by
                  the Name attribute of the Algorithm element. For
                  valid values see section 12. IANA Considerations.

Authentication Response Component

The Authentication Response Component contains the results of an authentication request. It uses the Algorithm contained in the Authentication Request Component (see section 7.2) selected from the Authentication Request Block (see section 8.4).

Depending on the Algorithm selected, the results of applying the algorithm will either be contained in a Signature Component that signs both the Authentication Response and potentially other data, or in the Packaged Content elements within the Authentication Response Component. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT AuthResp (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST AuthResp

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
AuthenticationId   CDATA   #REQUIRED
SelectedAlgorithmRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                      Authentication Response Component within the
                      IOTP Transaction.

AuthenticationId The Authentication identifier specified by the

                      Authenticator that was included in the
                      Authentication Request Component(see section
                      7.2). This will enable the Authenticator to
                      identify the Authentication that is being
                      referred to.

SelectedAlgorithmRef An Element Reference that identifies the

                      Algorithm element used to generate the
                      Authentication Response.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14.Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent This may contain the response generated as a

                  result of applying the Algorithm selected from the
                  Authentication Request Component see section 7.2.
                  For example, for a payment specific scheme, it may
                  contain scheme-specific data. Refer to the scheme-
                  specific supplemental documentation for
                  definitions of its content.

Trading Role Information Request Component

This Trading Component contains a list of Trading Roles (see section 2.1) about which information is being requested. The result of a Trading Role Request is a set of Organisation Components (see section 7.6) that describe each of the Trading Roles requested.

Example usage includes:

o a Merchant requesting that a Consumer provides Organisation

  Components for the Consumer and DelivTo Trading Roles

o a Consumer requesting from a Merchant, information about the

  Payment Handlers and Delivery Handlers that the Merchant uses.

Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT TradingRoleInfoReq EMPTY> <!ATTLIST TradingRoleInfoReq

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
TradingRoleList    NMTOKENS #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Trading Role Information Request Component within
                  the IOTP Transaction.

TradingRoleList Contains a list of one or more Trading Roles (see

                  the TradingRole attribute of the Trading Role
                  Element - section 7.6.2) for which information is
                  being requested.

Order Component

An Order Component contains information about an order. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT Order (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST Order

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OrderIdentifier    CDATA   #REQUIRED
ShortDesc          CDATA   #REQUIRED
OkFrom             CDATA   #REQUIRED
OkTo               CDATA   #REQUIRED
ApplicableLaw      CDATA   #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Order

                  Component within the IOTP Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child

                  elements within this component, unless overridden
                  by an xml:lang attribute on a child element. See
                  section 3.8 Identifying Languages.

OrderIdentifier This is a code, reference number or other

                  identifier which the creator of the Order may use
                  to identify the order. It must be unique within an
                  IOTP Transaction. If it is used in this way, then
                  it may remove the need to specify any content for
                  the Order element as the reference can be used to
                  look up the necessary information in a database.

ShortDesc A short description of the order in the language

                  defined by xml:lang. It is used to facilitate
                  selecting an individual order from a list of
                  orders, for example from a database of orders
                  which has been stored by a Consumer, Merchant,
                  etc.

OkFrom The date and time in [UTC] format after which the

                  offer made by the Merchant lapses.

OkTo The date and time in [UTC] format before which a

                  Value Acquirer may accept the offer made by the
                  Merchant is not valid.

ApplicableLaw A phrase in the language defined by xml:lang which

                  describes the state or country of jurisdiction
                  which will apply in resolving problems or
                  disputes.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14.Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent An optional description of the order information

                  as one or more Packaged Contents (see section
                  3.7).

Order Description Content

The Packaged Content element will normally be required, however it may be omitted where sufficient information about the purchase can be provided in the ShortDesc attribute. If the full Order Description requires it several Packaged Content elements may be used.

Although the amount and currency are likely to appear in the Packaged Content of the Order Description it is the amount and currency contained in the payment related trading components (Brand List, Brand Selection and Payment) that is authoritative. This means it is important that the amount actually being paid (as contained in the payment related trading components) is prominently displayed to the Consumer.

For interoperability, implementations must support Plain Text, HTML and XML as a minimum so that it can be easily displayed.

OkFrom and OkTo Timestamps

Note that:

o the OkFrom date may be later than the OkFrom date on the Payment

  Component (see section 7.9) associated with this order, and

o similarly, the OkTo date may be earlier that the OkTo date on the

  Payment Component (see section 7.9).

Note: Disclaimer. The following information provided in this note does not represent formal advice of any of the authors of this specification. Readers of this specification must form their own views and seek their own legal counsel on the usefulness and applicability of this information.

The merchant in the context of Internet commerce with anonymous consumers initially frames the terms of the offer on the web page, and in order to obtain the goods or services, the consumer must accept them.

If there is to be a time-limited offer, it is recommended that merchants communicate this to the consumer and state in the order description in a manner which is clear to the consumer that:

o the offer is time limited

o the OkFrom and OkTo timestamps specify the validity of the offer

o the clock, e.g., the merchant's clock, that will be used to

  determine the validity of the offer

Also note that although the OkFrom and OkTo dates are likely to appear in the Packaged Content of the Order Description it is the dates contained in the Order Component that is authoritative. This means it is important that the OkFrom and OkTo dates actually being used is prominently displayed to the Consumer.

Organisation Component

The Organisation Component provides information about an individual or an Organisation. This can be used for a variety of purposes. For example:

o to describe the merchant who is selling the goods,

o to identify who made a purchase,

o to identify who will take delivery of goods,

o to provide a customer care contact,

o to describe who will be the Payment Handler.

Note that the Organisation Components which must be present in an IOTP Message are dependent on the particular transaction being carried out. Refer to section 9. Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions, for more details.

Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT Org (TradingRole+, ContactInfo?,

    PersonName?, PostalAddress?)>

<!ATTLIST Org

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OrgId              CDATA   #REQUIRED
LegalName          CDATA   #IMPLIED
ShortDesc          CDATA   #IMPLIED
LogoNetLocn        CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Organisation Component within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child

                  elements within this component, unless overridden
                  by an xml:lang attribute on a child element. See
                  section 3.8 Identifying Languages.

OrgId A code which identifies the Organisation described

                  by the Organisation Component. See 7.6.1
                  Organisation IDs, below.

LegalName For Organisations which are companies this is

                  their legal name in the language defined by
                  xml:lang. It is required for Organisations who
                  have a Trading Role other than Consumer or
                  DelivTo.

ShortDesc A short description of the Organisation in the

                  language defined by xml:lang. It is typically the
                  name by which the Organisation is commonly known.
                  For example, if the legal name was "Blue Meadows
                  Financial Services Inc.". Then its short name
                  would likely be "Blue Meadows".
                  It is used to facilitate selecting an individual
                  Organisation from a list of Organisations, for
                  example from a database of Organisations involved
                  in IOTP Transactions which has been stored by a
                  consumer.

LogoNetLocn The net location which can be used to download the

                  logo for the Organisation.
                  See section 10 Retrieving Logos.
                  The content of this attribute must conform to
                  RFC1738.

Content:

TradingRole See 7.6.2 Trading Role Element below.

ContactInfo See 7.6.3 Contact Information Element below.

PersonName See 7.6.4 Person Name below.

PostalAddress See 7.6.5 Postal Address below.

Organisation IDs

Organisation IDs are used by one IOTP Trading Role to identify another. In order to avoid confusion, this means that these IDs must be globally unique.

In principle this is achieved in the following way:

o the Organisation Id for all trading roles, apart from the Consumer

  Trading Role, uses a domain name as their globally unique
  identifier,

o the Organisation Id for a Consumer Trading Role is allocated by

  one of the other Trading Roles in an IOTP Transaction and is made
  unique by concatenating it with that other roles' Organisation Id,

o once a Consumer is allocated an Organisation Id within an IOTP

  Transaction the same Organisation Id is used by all the other
  trading roles in that IOTP transaction to identify that Consumer.

Specifically, the content of the Organisation ID is defined as follows:

OrgId ::= NonConsumerOrgId | ConsumerOrgId NonConsumerOrgId ::= DomainName ConsumerOrgId ::= ConsumerOrgIdPrefix (namechar)+ "/" NonConsumerOrgId ConsumerOrgIdPrefix ::= "Consumer:"

ConsumerOrgId The Organisation ID for a Consumer consists of:

                   o a standard prefix to identify that the
                     Organisation Id is for a consumer, followed by
                   o one or more characters which conform to the
                     definition of an XML "namechar". See [XML]
                     specifications, followed by
                   o the NonConsumerOrgId for the Organisation
                     which allocated the ConsumerOrgId. It is
                     normally the Merchant role.
                  Use of upper and lower case is not significant.

NonConsumerOrgId If the Role is not Consumer then this contains the

                  Canonical Name for the non-consumer Organisation
                  being described by the Organisation Component. See
                  [DNS] optionally followed by additional
                  characters, if required, to make the
                  NonConsumerOrgId unique.
                  Note that a NonConsumerOrgId may not start with
                  the ConsumerOrgIdPrefix.
                  Use of upper and lower case is not significant.

Examples of Organisation Ids follow:

o newjerseybooks.com - a merchant Organisation id

o westernbank.co.uk - a Payment Handler Organisation id

o consumer:1000247ABH/newjerseybooks.com - a consumer Organisation

  id allocated by a merchant

Trading Role Element

This identifies the Trading Role of an individual or Organisation in the IOTP Transaction. Note, an Organisation may have more than one Trading Role and several roles may be present in one Organisation element. Its definition is as follows:

<!ELEMENT TradingRole EMPTY > <!ATTLIST TradingRole

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
TradingRole        NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
IotpMsgIdPrefix    NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
CancelNetLocn      CDATA   #IMPLIED
ErrorNetLocn       CDATA   #IMPLIED
ErrorLogNetLocn    CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Trading Role Element within the IOTP Transaction.

TradingRole The trading role of the Organisation. Valid values

                  are:
                   o Consumer. The person or Organisation that is
                     acting in the role of a consumer in the IOTP
                     Transaction.
                   o Merchant. The person or Organisation that is
                     acting in the role of merchant in the IOTP
                     Transaction.
                   o PaymentHandler. The financial institution or
                     other Organisation which is a Payment Handler
                     for the IOTP Transaction
                   o DeliveryHandler. The person or Organisation
                     that is the delivering the goods or services
                     for the IOTP Transaction
                   o DelivTo. The person or Organisation that is
                     receiving the delivery of goods or services in
                     the IOTP Transaction
                   o CustCare. The Organisation and/or individual
                     who will provide customer care for an IOTP
                     Transaction.
                  Values of TradingRole are controlled under the
                  procedures defined in section 12 IANA
                  Considerations which also allows user defined
                  values to be defined.

IotpMsgIdPrefix Contains the prefix which must be used for all

                  IOTP Messages sent by the Trading Role in this
                  IOTP Transaction. The values to be used are
                  defined in 3.4.1 IOTP Message ID Attribute
                  Definition.

CancelNetLocn This contains the net location of where the

                  Consumer should go to if the Consumer cancels the
                  transaction for some reason. It can be used by the
                  Trading Role to provide a response which is more
                  tailored to the circumstances of a particular
                  transaction.
                  This attribute:
                   o must not be present when TradingRole is set to
                     Consumer role or DelivTo,
                   o must be present when TradingRole is set to
                     Merchant, PaymentHandler or DeliveryHandler.
                  The content of this attribute is dependent on the
                  Transport Mechanism see the Transport Mechanism
                  Supplement.

ErrorNetLocn This contains the net location that should be

                  displayed by the Consumer after the Consumer has
                  either received or generated an Error Block
                  containing an Error Component with the Severity
                  attribute set to either:
                   o HardError,
                   o Warning but the Consumer decides to not
                     continue with the transaction
                   o TransientError and the transaction has
                     subsequently timed out.
                  See section 7.21.1 Error Processing Guidelines for
                  more details.
                  This attribute:
                   o must not be present when TradingRole is set to
                     Consumer or DelivTo,
                   o must be present when TradingRole is set to
                     Merchant, PaymentHandler or DeliveryHandler.
                  The content of this attribute is dependent on the
                  Transport Mechanism see the Transport Mechanism
                  Supplement.

ErrorLogNetLocn Optional. This contains the net location that

                  Consumers should send IOTP Messages that contain
                  Error Blocks with an Error Component with the
                  Severity attribute set to either:
                   o HardError,
                   o Warning but the Consumer decides to not
                     continue with the transaction
                   o TransientError and the transaction has
                     subsequently timed out.
                  This attribute:
                   o must not be present when TradingRole is set to
                     Consumer role,
                   o must be present when TradingRole is set to
                     Merchant, PaymentHandler or DeliveryHandler.
                  The content of this attribute is dependent on the
                  Transport Mechanism see the Transport Mechanism
                  Supplement.
                  The ErrorLogNetLocn can be used to send error
                  messages to the software company or some other
                  Organisation responsible for fixing problems in
                  the software which sent the incoming message. See
                  section 7.21.1 Error Processing Guidelines for
                  more details.

Contact Information Element

This contains information which can be used to contact an Organisation or an individual. All attributes are optional however at least one item of contact information should be present. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT ContactInfo EMPTY > <!ATTLIST ContactInfo

xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Tel                CDATA   #IMPLIED
Fax                CDATA   #IMPLIED
Email              CDATA   #IMPLIED
NetLocn            CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within

                  this element. See section 3.8 Identifying
                  Languages.

Tel A telephone number by which the Organisation may

                  be contacted. Note that this is a text field and
                  no validation is carried out on it.

Fax A fax number by which the Organisation may be

                  contacted. Note that this is a text field and no
                  validation is carried out on it.

Email An email address by which the Organisation may be

                  contacted. Note that this field should conform to
                  the conventions for address specifications
                  contained in RFC822.

NetLocn A location on the Internet by which information

                  about the Organisation may be obtained that can be
                  displayed using a web browser.
                  The content of this attribute must conform to
                  RFC1738.

Person Name Element

This contains the name of an individual person. All fields are optional however as a minimum either the GivenName or the FamilyName should be present. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PersonName EMPTY > <!ATTLIST PersonName

xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Title              CDATA   #IMPLIED
GivenName          CDATA   #IMPLIED
Initials           CDATA   #IMPLIED
FamilyName         CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within

                  this element. See section 3.8 Identifying
                  Languages.

Title A distinctive name; personal appellation,

                  hereditary or not, denoting or implying office
                  (e.g., judge, mayor) or nobility (e.g., duke,
                  duchess, earl), or used in addressing or referring
                  to a person (e.g., Mr, Mrs, Miss)

GivenName The primary or main name by which a person is

                  known amongst and identified by their family,
                  friends and acquaintances. Otherwise known as
                  first name or Christian Name.

Initials The first letter of the secondary names (other

                  than the Given Name) by which a person is known
                  amongst or identified by their family, friends and
                  acquaintances.

FamilyName The name by which family of related individuals

                  are known. It is typically the part of an
                  individual's name which is passed on by parents to
                  their children.

Postal Address Element

This contains an address which can be used, for example, for the physical delivery of goods, services or letters. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PostalAddress EMPTY > <!ATTLIST PostalAddress

xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AddressLine1       CDATA   #IMPLIED
AddressLine2       CDATA   #IMPLIED
CityOrTown         CDATA   #IMPLIED
StateOrRegion      CDATA   #IMPLIED
PostalCode         CDATA   #IMPLIED
Country            CDATA   #IMPLIED
LegalLocation (True | False) 'False' >

Attributes:

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within

                  this element. See section 3.8 Identifying
                  Languages.

AddressLine1 The first line of a postal address. e.g., "The

                  Meadows"

AddressLine2 The second line of a postal address. e.g., "Sandy

                  Lane"

CityOrTown The city of town of the address. e.g., "Carpham"

StateOrRegion The state or region within a country where the

                  city or town is placed. e.g., "Surrey"

PostalCode The code known as, for example a post code or zip

                  code, that is typically used by Postal
                  Organisations to organise postal deliveries into
                  efficient sequences. e.g., "KT22 1AA"

Country The country for the address. e.g., "UK"

LegalLocation This identifies whether the address is the

                  Registered Address for the Organisation. At least
                  one address for the Organisation must have a value
                  set to True unless the Trading Role is either
                  Consumer or DeliverTo.

Brand List Component

Brand List Components are contained within the Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 8.1) of the IOTP Transaction. They contains lists of:

o payment Brands (see also section 11.1 Brand Definitions and Brand

  Selection),

o amounts to be paid in the currencies that are accepted or offered

  by the Merchant,

o the payment protocols which can be used to make payments with a

  Brand, and

o the net locations of the Payment Handlers which accept payment for

  a payment protocol

The definition of a Brand List Component is as follows.

<!ELEMENT BrandList (Brand+, ProtocolAmount+,

CurrencyAmount+, PayProtocol+) >

<!ATTLIST BrandList

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ShortDesc          CDATA   #REQUIRED
PayDirection (Debit | Credit) #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Brand

                  List Component within the IOTP Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child

                  elements within this component, unless overridden
                  by an xml:lang attribute on a child element. See
                  section 3.8 Identifying Languages.

ShortDesc A text description in the language defined by

                  xml:Lang giving details of the purpose of the
                  Brand List.  This information must be displayed to
                  the receiver of the Brand List in order to assist
                  with making the selection. It is of particular
                  benefit in allowing a Consumer to distinguish the
                  purpose of a Brand List when an IOTP Transaction
                  involves more than one payment.

PayDirection Indicates the direction in which the payment for

                  which a Brand is being selected is to be made. Its
                  values may be:
                   o Debit The sender of the Payment Request Block
                     (e.g., the Consumer) to which this Brand List
                     relates will make the payment to the Payment
                     Handler, or
                   o Credit The sender of the Payment Request Block
                     to which this Brand List relates will receive a
                     payment from the Payment Handler.

Content:

Brand This describes a Brand. The sequence of the Brand

                  elements (see section 7.7.1) within the Brand List
                  does not indicate any preference. It is
                  recommended that software which processes this
                  Brand List presents Brands in a sequence which the
                  receiver of the Brand List prefers.

ProtocolAmount This links a particular Brand to:

                   o the currencies and amounts in CurrencyAmount
                     elements that can be used with the Brand, and
                   o the Payment Protocols and Payment Handlers,
                     which can be used with those currencies and
                     amounts, and a particular Brand

CurrencyAmount This contains a currency code and an amount.

PayProtocol This contains information about a Payment Protocol

                  and the Payment Handler which may be used with a
                  particular Brand.

The relationships between the elements which make up the content of the Brand List is illustrated in the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
                Brand List Component
                  |                   ProtocolAmountRefs
                  |-Brand Element-----------------------------
                  |  |                                        |
                  |   - Protocol Brand Element--------        |
                  |                                   |       |
                  |                         ProtocolId|       |
                  |                                   |       |
                  |-Protocol Amount Element<----------+-------
                  |  |                      |         |
                  |  |                      |         |
                  |  |CurrencyAmountRefs    |Pay      |
                  |  |                      |Protocol |
                  |  v                      |Ref      |
                  |-Currency Amount Element |         |
                  | Element                 |         |
                  |                         |         |
                   -PayProtocolElement<------<--------
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
               Figure 15 Brand List Element Relationships

Examples of complete Brand Lists are contained in section 11.2 Brand List Examples.

Brand Element

A Brand Element describes a brand that can be used for making a payment. One or more of these elements is carried in each Brand List Component that has the PayDirection attribute set to Debit. Exactly one Brand Element may be carried in a Brand List Component that has the PayDirection attribute set to Credit.

<!ELEMENT Brand (ProtocolBrand*, PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST Brand

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
BrandId            CDATA   #REQUIRED
BrandName          CDATA   #REQUIRED
BrandLogoNetLocn   CDATA   #REQUIRED
BrandNarrative     CDATA   #IMPLIED
ProtocolAmountRefs IDREFS  #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID Element identifier, potentially referenced in a

                   Brand Selection Component contained in a later
                   Payment Request message and uniquely identifies
                   the Brand element within the IOTP Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes and

                   content of this element. See section 3.8
                   Identifying Languages.

BrandId This contains a unique identifier for the brand

                   (or promotional brand). It is used to match
                   against a list of Payment Instruments which the
                   Consumer holds to determine whether or not the
                   Consumer can pay using the Brand.
                   Values of BrandId are managed under the procedure
                   described in section 12 IANA Considerations.
                   As values of BrandId are controlled under the
                   procedures defined in section 12 IANA
                   Considerations user defined values may be
                   defined.

BrandName This contains the name of the brand, for example

                   MasterCard Credit. This is the description of the
                   Brand which is displayed to the consumer in the
                   Consumers language defined by xml:lang. For
                   example it might be "American Airlines Advantage
                   Visa". Note that this attribute is not used for
                   matching against the payment instruments held by
                   the Consumer.

BrandLogoNetLocn The net location which can be used to download

                   the logo for the Organisation. See section
                   Retrieving Logos (see section 10).
                   The content of this attribute must conform to
                   RFC1738.

BrandNarrative This optional attribute is designed to be used by

                   the Merchant to indicate some special conditions
                   or benefit which would apply if the Consumer
                   selected that brand. For example "5% discount",
                   "free shipping and handling", "free breakage
                   insurance for 1 year", "double air miles apply",
                   etc.

ProtocolAmountRefs Identifies the protocols and related currencies

                   and amounts which can be used with this Brand.
                   Specified as a list of ID's of Protocol Amount
                   Elements (see section 7.7.3) contained within the
                   Brand List.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14.Glossary.

Content:

ProtocolBrand Protocol Brand elements contain brand information

                  to be used with a specific payment protocol (see
                  section 7.7.2)

PackagedContent Optional Packaged Content (see section 3.7)

                  elements containing information about the brand
                  which may be used by the payment protocol. The
                  content of this information is defined in the
                  supplement for a payment protocol which describes
                  how the payment protocol works with IOTP.

Example Brand Elements are contained in section 11.2 Brand List Examples.

Protocol Brand Element

The Protocol Brand Element contains information that is specific to the use of a particular Protocol with a Brand. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT ProtocolBrand (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST ProtocolBrand

ProtocolId         CDATA   #REQUIRED
ProtocolBrandId    CDATA   #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ProtocolId This must match the value of a ProtocolId

                  attribute in a Pay Protocol Element (see section
                  7.7.5).
                  The values of ProtocolId should be unique within a
                  Brand Element otherwise there is an error.

ProtocolBrandId This is the Payment Brand Id to be used with a

                  particular payment protocol. For example, SET and
                  EMV have their own well defined, yet different,
                  values for the Brand Id to be used with each
                  protocol.
                  The valid values of this attribute are defined in
                  the supplement for the payment protocol identified
                  by ProtocolId that describes how the payment
                  protocol works with IOTP.

Content:

PackagedContent Optional Packaged Content (see section 3.7)

                  elements containing information about the
                  protocol/brand which may be used by the payment
                  protocol. The content of this information is
                  defined in the supplement for a payment protocol
                  which describes how the payment protocol works
                  with IOTP.

Protocol Amount Element

The Protocol Amount element links a Brand to:

o the currencies and amounts in Currency Amount Elements (see

  section 7.7.4) that can be used with the Brand, and

o the Payment Protocols and Payment Handlers defined in a Pay

  Protocol Element (see section 7.7.5), which can be used with those
  currencies and amounts.

Its definition is as follows:

<!ELEMENT ProtocolAmount (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST ProtocolAmount

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
PayProtocolRef     IDREF   #REQUIRED
CurrencyAmountRefs IDREFS  #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID Element identifier, potentially referenced in a

                   Brand element; or in a Brand Selection Component
                   contained in a later Payment Request message
                   which uniquely identifies the Protocol Amount
                   element within the IOTP Transaction.

PayProtocolRef Contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5)

                   that refers to the Pay Protocol Element (see
                   section 7.7.5) that contains the Payment Protocol
                   and Payment Handlers that can be used with the
                   Brand.

CurrencyAmountRefs Contains a list of Element References (see

                   section 3.5) that refer to the Currency Amount
                   Element (see section 7.7.4) that describes the
                   currencies and amounts that can be used with the
                   Brand.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Optional Packaged Content (see section 3.7)

                  elements containing information about the protocol
                  amount which may be used by the payment protocol.
                  The content of this information is defined in the
                  supplement for a payment protocol which describes
                  how the payment protocol works with IOTP.

Examples of Protocol Amount Elements are contained in section 11.2 Brand List Examples.

Currency Amount Element

A Currency Amount element contains:

o a currency code (and its type), and

o an amount.

One or more of these elements is carried in each Brand List Component. Its definition is as follows:

<!ELEMENT CurrencyAmount EMPTY > <!ATTLIST CurrencyAmount

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
Amount             CDATA   #REQUIRED
CurrCodeType       NMTOKEN 'ISO4217-A'
CurrCode           CDATA   #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID Element identifier, potentially referenced in a

                  Brand element; or in a Brand Selection Component
                  contained in a later Payment Request message which
                  uniquely identifies the Currency Amount Element
                  within the IOTP Transaction.

Amount Indicates the amount to be paid in whole and

                  fractional units of the currency. For example
                  $245.35 would be expressed "245.35". Note that
                  values smaller than the smallest denomination are
                  allowed. For example one tenth of a cent would be
                  "0.001".

CurrCodeType Indicates the domain of the CurrCode. This

                  attribute is included so that the currency code
                  may support non-standard "currencies" such as
                  frequent flyer points, trading stamps, etc. Its
                  values may be:
                   o ISO4217-A (the default) indicates the currency
                     code is a three character alphabetic currency
                     code that conforms to [ISO 4217]
                   o IOTP indicates that values of CurrCode are
                     managed under the procedure described in
                     section 12 IANA Considerations

CurrCode A code which identifies the currency to be used in

                  the payment. The domain of valid currency codes is
                  defined by CurrCodeType
                  As values of CurrCodeType are managed under the
                  procedure described in section 12 IANA
                  Considerations user defined values of CurrCodeType
                  may be defined.

Examples of Currency Amount Elements are contained in section 11.2 Brand List Examples.

Pay Protocol Element

A Pay Protocol element specifies details of a Payment Protocol and the Payment Handler that can be used with a Brand. One or more of these elements is carried in each Brand List.

<!ELEMENT PayProtocol (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST PayProtocol

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProtocolId         NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProtocolName       CDATA   #REQUIRED
ActionOrgRef       NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
PayReqNetLocn      CDATA   #IMPLIED
SecPayReqNetLocn   CDATA   #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID Element identifier, potentially referenced in a

                  Brand element; or in a Brand Selection Component
                  contained in a later Payment Request message which
                  uniquely identifies the Pay Protocol element
                  within the IOTP Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes and

                  content of this element. See section 3.8
                  Identifying Languages.

ProtocolId Consists of a protocol name and version. For

                  example "SETv1.0".
                  The values of ProtocolId are defined by the
                  payment scheme/method owners in the document that
                  describes how to encapsulate a payment protocol
                  within IOTP.

ProtocolName A narrative description of the payment protocol

                  and its version in the language identified by
                  xml:lang. For example "Secure Electronic
                  Transaction Version 1.0". Its purpose is to help
                  provide information on the payment protocol being
                  used if problems arise.

ActionOrgRef An Element Reference (see section 3.5) to the

                  Organisation Component for the Payment Handler for
                  the Payment Protocol.

PayReqNetLocn The Net Location indicating where an unsecured

                  Payment Request message should be sent if this
                  protocol choice is used.
                  The content of this attribute is dependent on the
                  Transport Mechanism (such must conform to
                  RFC1738.

SecPayReqNetLocn The Net Location indicating where a secured

                  Payment Request message should be sent if this
                  protocol choice is used.
                  A secured payment involves the use of a secure
                  channel such as [SSL/TLS] in order to communicate
                  with the Payment Handler.
                  The content of this attribute must conform to
                  RFC1738. See also See section 3.9 Secure and
                  Insecure Net Locations.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Optional Packaged Content elements (see section

                  3.7) containing information about the protocol
                  which is used by the payment protocol. The content
                  of this information is defined in the supplement
                  for a payment protocol which describes how the
                  payment protocol works with IOTP. An example of
                  its use could be to include a payment protocol
                  message.

Examples of Pay Protocol Elements are contained in section 11.2 Brand List Examples.

Brand Selection Component

A Brand Selection Component identifies the choice of payment brand, payment protocol and the Payment Handler. This element is used:

o in Payment Request messages within Baseline Purchase and Baseline

  Value Exchange IOTP Transactions to identify the brand, protocol
  and payment handler for a payment, or

o to, optionally, inform a merchant in a purchase of the payment

  brand being used so that the offer and order details can be
  amended accordingly.

In Baseline IOTP, the integrity of Brand Selection Components is not guaranteed. However, modification of Brand Selection Components can only cause denial of service if the payment protocol itself is secure against message modification, duplication, and swapping attacks.

The definition of a Brand Selection Component is as follows.

<!ELEMENT BrandSelection (BrandSelBrandInfo?,

    BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo?,
    BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo?) >

<!ATTLIST BrandSelection

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
BrandListRef       NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
BrandRef           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProtocolAmountRef  NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
CurrencyAmountRef  NMTOKEN #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Brand

                  Selection Component within the IOTP Transaction.

BrandListRef The Element Reference (see section 3.5) of the

                  Brand List Component from which a Brand is being
                  selected

BrandRef The Element Reference of a Brand element within

                  the Brand List Component that is being selected
                  that is to be used in the payment.

ProtocolAmountRef The Element Reference of a Protocol Amount element

                  within the Brand List Component which is to be
                  used when making the payment.

CurrencyAmountRef The Element Reference of a Currency Amount element

                  within the Brand List Component which is to be
                  used when making the payment.

Content:

BrandSelBrandInfo, This contains any additional data that BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo, may be required by a particular payment BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo brand or protocol. See sections 7.8.1,

                             7.8.2, and 7.8.3.

The following rules apply:

o the BrandListRef must contain the ID of a Brand List Component in

  the same IOTP Transaction

o every Brand List Component in the Trading Protocol Options Block

  (see section 8.1) must be referenced by one and only one Brand
  Selection Component

o the BrandRef must refer to the ID of a Brand contained within the

  Brand List Component referred to by BrandListRef

o the ProtocolAmountRef must refer to one of the Element IDs listed

  in the ProtocolAmountRefs attribute of the Brand element
  identified by BrandRef

o the CurrencyAmountRef must refer to one of the Element IDs listed

  in the CurrencyAmountRefs attribute of the Protocol Amount Element
  identified by ProtocolAmountRef.

An example of a Brand Selection Component is included in 11.2 Brand List Examples.

Brand Selection Brand Info Element

The Brand Selection Brand Info Element contains any additional data that may be required by a particular payment brand. See the IOTP payment method supplement for a description of how and when it used.

<!ELEMENT BrandSelBrandInfo (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST BrandSelBrandInfo

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Packaged Content elements (see section 3.7) that

                  contain additional data that may be required by a
                  particular payment brand. See the payment method
                  supplement for IOTP for rules on how this is used.

Brand Selection Protocol Amount Info Element

The Brand Selection Protocol Amount Info Element contains any additional data that is payment protocol specific that may be required by a particular payment brand or payment protocol. See the IOTP payment method supplement for a description of how and when it used.

<!ELEMENT BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Packaged Content elements (see section 3.7) that

                  may contain additional data that may be required
                  by a particular payment brand. See the payment
                  method supplement for IOTP for rules on how this
                  is used.

Brand Selection Currency Amount Info Element

The Brand Selection Currency Amount Info Element contains any additional data that is payment brand and currency specific that may be required by a particular payment brand. See the IOTP payment method supplement for a description of how and when it used.

<!ELEMENT BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Packaged Content elements (see section 3.7) that

                  contain additional data relating to the payment
                  brand and currency. See the payment method
                  supplement for IOTP for rules on how this is used.

Payment Component

A Payment Component contains information used to control how a payment is carried out. Its provides information on:

o the times within which a Payment with a Payment Handler may be

  started

o a reference to the Brand List (see section 7.7) which identifies

  the Brands, protocols, currencies and amounts which can be used to
  make a payment

o whether or not a payment receipt will be provided

o whether another payment precedes this payment.

Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT Payment EMPTY > <!ATTLIST Payment

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
OkFrom             CDATA   #REQUIRED
OkTo               CDATA   #REQUIRED
BrandListRef       NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
SignedPayReceipt (True | False) #REQUIRED
StartAfterRefs     NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Payment Component within the IOTP Transaction.

OkFrom The date and time in [UTC] format after which a

                  Payment Handler may accept for processing a
                  Payment Request Block (see section 8.7) containing
                  the Payment Component.

OkTo The date and time in [UTC] format before which a

                  Payment Handler may accept for processing a
                  Payment Request Block containing the Payment
                  Component.

BrandListRef An Element Reference (see section 3.5) of a Brand

                  List Component (see section 7.7) within the TPO
                  Trading Block for the IOTP Transaction. The Brand
                  List identifies the alternative ways in which the
                  payment can be made.

SignedPayReceipt Indicates whether or not the Payment Response

                  Block (see section 8.9) generated by the Payment
                  Handler for the payment must be digitally signed.

StartAfter Contains Element References (see section 3.5) of

                  other Payment Components which describe payments
                  which must be complete before this payment can
                  start. If no StartAfter attribute is present then
                  there are no dependencies and the payment can
                  start immediately

7.10 Payment Scheme Component

A Payment Scheme Component contains payment protocol information for a specific payment scheme which is transferred between the parties involved in a payment for example a [SET] message. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PaySchemeData (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST PaySchemeData

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
PaymentRef         NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ConsumerPaymentId  CDATA   #IMPLIED
PaymentHandlerPayId CDATA  #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                    Payment Scheme Component within the IOTP
                    Transaction.

PaymentRef An Element Reference (see section 3.5) to the

                    Payment Component (see section 7.9) to which
                    this Payment Scheme Component relates. It is
                    required unless the Payment Scheme Component is
                    part of an Transaction Inquiry Status
                    Transaction (see section 9.2.1).

ConsumerPaymentId An identifier specified by the Consumer which,

                    if returned by the Payment Handler in another
                    Payment Scheme Component or by other means, will
                    enable the Consumer to identify which payment is
                    being referred to.

PaymentHandlerPayId An identifier specified by the Payment Handler

                    which, if returned by the Consumer in another
                    Payment Scheme Component, or by other means,
                    will enable the Payment Handler to identify
                    which payment is being referred to. It is
                    required on every Payment Scheme Component apart
                    from the one contained in a Payment Request
                    Block.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Contains payment scheme protocol information as

                  Packaged Content elements (see section 3.7). See
                  the payment scheme supplement for the definition
                  of its content.
                  Note that:
                   o the values of the Name attribute of each
                     packaged content element are defined by the
                     Payment Protocol Supplement
                   o the value of each Name must be unique within a
                     Payment where a Payment is defined as all
                     Payment Scheme or Payment Receipt Components
                     with the same value of the PaymentRef attribute

7.11 Payment Receipt Component

A Payment Receipt is a record of a payment which demonstrates how much money has been paid or received. It is distinct from a purchase receipt in that it contains no record of what was being purchased.

Typically the content of a Payment Receipt Component will contain data which describes:

o the amount paid and its currency

o the date and time of the payment

o internal reference numbers which identify the payment to the

  payment system

o potentially digital signatures generated by the payment method

  which can be used to prove after the event that the payment
  occurred.

If the Payment Method being used provides the facility then the Payment Receipt Component should contain payment protocol messages, or references to messages, which prove the payment occurred.

The precise definition of the content is Payment Method dependent. Refer to the supplement for the payment method being used to determine the rules that apply.

Information contained in the Payment Receipt Component should be displayed or otherwise made available to the Consumer.

Note: If the Payment Receipt Component contains Payment Protocol Messages, then the Messages will need to be processed by Payment Method software to convert it into a format which can be understood by the Consumer

The definition of a Payment Receipt Component is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PayReceipt (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST PayReceipt

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
PaymentRef         NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
PayReceiptNameRefs NMTOKENS #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                   Payment Receipt Component within the IOTP
                   Transaction.

PaymentRef Contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5)

                   to the Payment Component (see section 7.9) to
                   which this payment receipt applies

PayReceiptNameRefs Optionally contains a list of the values of the

                   Name attributes of Packaged Content elements that
                   together make up the receipt. The Packaged
                   Content elements are contained either within:
                    o Payment Scheme Data components exchanged
                      between the Payment Handler and the Consumer
                      roles during the Payment, and/or
                    o the Payment Receipt component itself.
                   Note that:
                    o each payment scheme defines in its supplement
                      the Names of the Packaged Content elements
                      that must be listed in this attribute (if
                      any).
                    o if a Payment Scheme Component contains
                      Packaged Content elements with a name that
                      matches a name within PayReceiptNameRefs, then
                      those Payment Scheme Components must be
                      referenced by Digests in the Payment Response
                      signature component (if such a signature is
                      being used)
                   The client software should save all the
                   components referenced so that the payment receipt
                   can be reconstructed when required.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Optionally contains payment scheme payment receipt

                  information as Packaged Content elements (see
                  section 3.7). See the payment scheme supplement
                  for the definition of its content.
                  Note that:
                   o the values of the Name attribute of each
                     packaged content element are defined by the
                     Payment Protocol Supplement
                   o the value of each Name must be unique within a
                     Payment where a Payment is defined as all
                     Payment Scheme or Payment Receipt Components,
                     with the same value of the PaymentRef attribute

Note that either the PayReceiptNameRefs attribute, the PackagedContent element, or both must be present.

7.12 Payment Note Component

The Payment Note Component contains additional, non payment related, information which the Payment Handler wants to provide to the Consumer. For example, if a withdrawal or deposit were being made then it could contain information on the remaining balance on the account after the transfer was complete. The information should duplicate information contained within the Payment Receipt Component.

Information contained in the Payment Note Component should be displayed or otherwise made available to the Consumer. For interoperability, the Payment Note Component should support, as a minimum, the content types of "Plain Text", HTML and XML. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PaymentNote (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST PaymentNote

 ID                ID      #REQUIRED
 ContentSoftwareId CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Payment Receipt Component within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Contains additional, non payment related,

                  information which the Payment Handler wants to
                  provide to the Consumer as one or more Packaged
                  Content elements (see section 3.7).

7.13 Delivery Component

The Delivery Element contains information required to deliver goods or services. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT Delivery (DeliveryData?, PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST Delivery

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivExch          (True | False) #REQUIRED
DelivAndPayResp    (True | False) #REQUIRED
ActionOrgRef       NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                   Delivery Component within the IOTP Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child

                   elements within this component, unless overridden
                   by an xml:lang attribute on a child element. See
                   section 3.8 Identifying Languages.

DelivExch Indicates if this IOTP Transaction includes the

                   messages associated with a Delivery Exchange.
                   Valid values are:
                    o True indicates it does include a Delivery
                      Exchange
                    o False indicates it does not include a
                      Delivery Exchange
                   If set to true then a DeliveryData element must
                   be present. If set to false it may be absent.

DelivAndPayResp Indicates if the Delivery Response Block (see

                   section 8.11) and the Payment Response Block (see
                   section 8.9 ) are combined into one IOTP Message.
                   Valid values are:
                    o True indicates both blocks will be in the
                      same IOTP Message, and
                    o False indicates each block will be in a
                      different IOTP Message
                   DelivAndPayResp should not be true if DelivExch
                   is False.
                   In practice combining the Delivery Response Block
                   and Payment Response Block is only likely to be
                   practical if the Merchant, the Payment Handler
                   and the Delivery Handler are the same
                   Organisation since:
                    o the Payment Handler must have access to Order
                      Component information so that they know what
                      to deliver, and
                    o the Payment Handler must be able to carry out
                      the delivery

ActionOrgRef An Element Reference to the Organisation

                   Component of the Delivery Handler for this
                   delivery.

Content:

DeliveryData Contains details about how the delivery will be

                  carried out. See 7.13.1 Delivery Data Element
                  below.

PackagedContent Contains "user" data defined for the Merchant

                  which is required by the Delivery Handler as one
                  or more Packaged Content Elements see section 3.7.

7.13.1 Delivery Data Element

The DeliveryData element contains information about where and how goods are to be delivered. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT DeliveryData (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST DeliveryData

xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
OkFrom             CDATA   #REQUIRED
OkTo               CDATA   #REQUIRED
DelivMethod        NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivToRef         NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivReqNetLocn    CDATA   #REQUIRED
SecDelivReqNetLocn CDATA   #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within

                   this component. See section 3.8 Identifying
                   Languages.

OkFrom The date and time in [UTC] format after which the

                   Delivery Handler may accept for processing a
                   Delivery Request Block (see section 8.10).

OkTo The date and time in [UTC] format before which

                   the Delivery Handler may accept for processing a
                   Delivery Request Block.

DelivMethod Indicates the method by which goods or services

                   may be delivered. Valid values are:
                    o Post the goods will be delivered by post or
                      courier
                    o Web the goods will be delivered
                      electronically in the Delivery Note Component
                    o Email the goods will be delivered
                      electronically by e-mail
                   Values of DelivMethod are managed under the
                   procedure described in section 12 IANA
                   Considerations which allows user defined codes to
                   be defined.

DelivToRef The Element Reference (see section 3.4) of an

                   Organisation Component within the IOTP
                   Transaction which has a role of DelivTo. The
                   information in this block is used to determine
                   where delivery is to be made. It must be
                   compatible with DelivMethod. Specifically if the
                   DelivMethod is:
                    o Post, then the there must be a Postal Address
                      Element containing sufficient information for
                      a postal delivery,
                    o Web, then there are no specific requirements.
                      The information will be sent in a web page
                      back to the Consumer
                    o Email, then there must be Contact Information
                      Element with a valid e-mail address

DelivReqNetLocn This contains the Net Location to which an

                   unsecured Delivery Request Block (see section
                   8.10) which contains the Delivery Component
                   should be sent.
                   The content of this attribute is dependent on the
                   Transport Mechanism and must conform to
                   RFC1738.

SecDelivReqNetLocn This contains the Net Location to which a secured

                   Delivery Request Block (see section 8.10) which
                   contains the Delivery Component should be sent.
                   A secured delivery request involves the use of a
                   secure channel such as [SSL/TLS] in order to
                   communicate with the Payment Handler.
                   The content of this attribute is dependent on the
                   Transport Mechanism must conform to RFC1738.
                   See also Section 3.9 Secure and Insecure Net
                   Locations.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Additional information about the delivery as one

                  or more Packaged Content elements (see section
                  3.7) provided to the Delivery Handler by the
                  merchant.

7.14 Consumer Delivery Data Component

A Consumer Delivery Data Component is used by a Consumer to specify an identifier that can be used by the Consumer to identify the Delivery.

Its definition is as follows:

<!ELEMENT ConsumerDeliveryData EMPTY > <!ATTLIST ConsumerDeliveryData

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
ConsumerDeliveryId CDATA   #REQUIRED>

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                   Consumer Delivery Data Component within the IOTP
                   Transaction.

ConsumerDeliveryId An identifier specified by the Consumer which, if

                   returned by the Delivery Handler will enable the
                   Consumer to identify which Delivery is being
                   referred to.

7.15 Delivery Note Component

A Delivery Note contains delivery instructions about the delivery of goods or services or potentially the actual Delivery Information itself. It is information which the person or Organisation receiving the Delivery Note can use when delivery occurs.

For interoperability, the Delivery Note Component Packaged Content should support both Plain Text, HTML and XML.

It's definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT DeliveryNote (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST DeliveryNote

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivHandlerDelivId CDATA  #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                    Delivery Note Component within the IOTP
                    Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child

                    elements within this component, unless
                    overridden by an xml:lang attribute on a child
                    element. See section 3.8 Identifying Languages.

DelivHandlerDelivId An optional identifier specified by the Delivery

                    Handler which, if returned by the Consumer in
                    another Delivery Component, or by other means,
                    will enable the Delivery Handler to identify
                    which Delivery is being referred to. It is
                    required on every Delivery Component apart from
                    the one contained in a Delivery Request Block.
                    An example use of this attribute is to contain a
                    delivery tracking number.

ContentSoftwareId See section 14. Glossary.

Content:

PackagedContent Contains actual delivery note information as one

                  or more Packaged Content elements (see section
                  3.7).

Note: If the content of the Delivery Message is a Mime message then the Delivery Note may trigger an application which causes the actual delivery to occur.

7.16 Status Component

A Status Component contains status information about the business success or failure (see section 4.2) of a process.

Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT Status EMPTY > <!ATTLIST Status

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
StatusType         NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ElRef              NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessState (NotYetStarted | InProgress |
    CompletedOk | Failed | ProcessError) #REQUIRED
CompletionCode     NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessReference   CDATA   #IMPLIED
StatusDesc         CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Status

                  Component within the IOTP Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes within

                  this component. See section 3.8 Identifying
                  Languages.

StatusType Indicates the type of Document Exchange which the

                  Status is reporting on. It may be set to either
                  Offer, Payment, Delivery, Authentication or
                  Undefined.
                  Undefined means that the type of document exchange
                  could not be identified. This is caused by an
                  error in the initial input message of the
                  exchange.
                  Values of StatusType are managed under the
                  procedure described in section 12 IANA
                  Considerations which also allows user defined
                  values of StatusType to be defined.

ElRef If the StatusType is not set to Undefined then

                  ElRef contains an Element Reference (see section
                  3.5) to the Component for which the Status is
                  being described. It must refer to either:
                   o an Order Component (see section 7.5), if the
                     StatusType is Offer,
                   o a Payment Component (see section 7.9), if the
                     StatusType is Payment, or
                   o a Delivery Component (see section 7.13), if
                     the StatusType is Delivery
                   o an Authentication Request Component (see
                     section 7.2) if the StatusType is
                     Authentication.

ProcessState Contains a State Code which indicates the current

                  state of the process being carried out. Valid
                  values for ProcessState are:
                   o NotYetStarted. A Request Block has been
                     received but the process has not yet started
                   o InProgress. Processing of the Request Block
                     has started but it is not yet complete
                   o CompletedOk. The processing of the Request
                     Block has completed successfully without any
                     errors
                   o Failed. The processing of the Request Block
                     has failed because of a Business Error (see
                     section 4.2)
                   o ProcessError. This value is only used when the
                     Status Component is being used in connection
                     with an Inquiry Request Trading Block (see
                     section 8.12). It indicates there was a
                     Technical Error (see section 4.1) in the
                     Request Block which is being processed or some
                     internal processing error.
                  Note that this code reports on the processing of a
                  Request Block. Further, asynchronous processing
                  may occur after the Response Block associated with
                  the Process has been sent.

CompletionCode Indicates how the process completed. Valid values

                  for the CompletionCode are given below together
                  with the conditions when it must be present and
                  indications on when recovery from failures are
                  possible.
                  A CompletionCode is a maximum of 14 characters
                  long.

ProcessReference This optional attribute holds a reference for the

                  process whose status is being reported. It may
                  hold the following values:
                   o when StatusType is set to Offer, it should
                     contain the OrderIdentifier from the Order
                     Component
                   o when StatusType is set to Payment, it should
                     contain the PaymentHandlerPayId from the
                     Payment Scheme Data Component
                   o when StatusType is set to Delivery, it should
                     contain the DelivHandlerDelivId from the
                     Delivery Note Component
                   o when StatusType is set to Authentication, it
                     should contain the AuthenticationId from the
                     Authentication Request Component
                  This attribute should be absent in the Inquiry
                  Request message when the Consumer has not been
                  given such a reference number by the IOTP Service
                  Provider.
                  This attribute can be used inside an Inquiry
                  Response Block (see section 8.13) to give the
                  reference number for a transaction which has
                  previously been unavailable.
                  For example, the package tracking number might not
                  be assigned at the time a delivery response was
                  received. However, if the Consumer issues a
                  Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry later, the
                  Delivery Handler can put the package tracking
                  number into this attribute in the Inquiry Response
                  message and send it back to the Consumer.

StatusDesc An optional textual description of the current

                  status of the process in the language identified
                  by xml:lang.

7.16.1 Offer Completion Codes

The Completion Code is only required if the ProcessState attribute is set to Failed. The following table contains the valid values for the CompletionCode that may be used and indicates whether or not recovery might be possible. It is recommended that the StatusDesc attribute is used to provide further explanation where appropriate.

   Value                            Description

AuthError Authentication Error. The check of the

                Authentication Response which was carried out has
                failed.
                Recovery may be possible by the Consumer re-
                submitting a new Authentication Response Block with
                corrected information.

ConsCancelled Consumer Cancelled. The Consumer decides to cancel

                the transaction for some reason. This code is only
                valid in a Status Component contained in a Cancel
                Block or an Inquiry Response Block.
                No recovery possible.

MerchCancelled Offer Cancelled. The Merchant declines to generate

                an offer for some reason and cancels the
                transaction. This code is only valid in a Status
                Component contained in a Cancel Block or an Inquiry
                Response Block.
                No recovery possible.

Unspecified Unspecified error. There is some unknown problem or

                error which does not fall into one of the other
                CompletionCodes.
                No recovery possible.

TimedOutRcvr Recoverable Time Out. Messages were resent but no

                response received. The document exchange has
                therefore "Timed Out". This code is only valid on a
                Transaction Inquiry.
                Recovery is possible if the last message from the
                other Trading Role is received again.

TimedOutNoRcvr Non Recoverable Time Out. Messages were resent but

                no response received. The document exchange has
                therefore "Timed Out". This code is only valid on a
                Transaction Inquiry.
                No recovery possible.

7.16.2 Payment Completion Codes

The CompletionCode is only required if the ProcessState attribute is set to Failed. The following table contains the valid values for the CompletionCode that may be used and indicates where recovery may be possible. It is recommended that the StatusDesc attribute is used by individual payment schemes to provide further explanation where appropriate.

     Value                           Description

BrandNotSupp Brand not supported. The payment brand is not

                  supported by the Payment Handler.
                  See below for recovery options.

CurrNotSupp Currency not supported. The currency in which the

                  payment is to be made is not supported by either
                  the Payment Instrument or the Payment Handler.
                  If the payment is Brand Independent, then the
                  Consumer may recover by selecting a different
                  currency, if available, or a different brand. Note
                  that this may involve a different Payment Handler.

ConsCancelled Consumer Cancelled. The Consumer decides to cancel

                  the payment for some reason. This code is only
                  valid in a Status Component contained in a Cancel
                  Block or an Inquiry Response Block.
                  Recovery is not possible.

PaymtCancelled Payment Cancelled. The Payment Handler declines to

                  complete the payment for some reason and cancels
                  the transaction. This code is only valid in a
                  Status Component contained in a Cancel Block or an
                  Inquiry Response Block.
                  See below for recovery options.

AuthError Authentication Error. The Payment Scheme specific

                  authentication check which was carried out has
                  failed.
                  Recovery may be possible. See the payment scheme
                  supplement to determine what is allowed.

InsuffFunds Insufficient funds. There are insufficient funds

                  available for the payment to be made.
                  See below for recovery options.

InstBrandInvalid Payment Instrument not valid for Brand. A Payment

                  Instrument is being used which does not correspond
                  with the Brand selected. For example a Visa credit
                  card is being used when MasterCard was selected as
                  the Brand.
                  See below for recovery options.

InstNotValid Payment instrument not valid for trade. The

                  Payment Instrument cannot be used for the proposed
                  type of trade, for some reason.
                  See below for recovery options.

BadInstrument Bad instrument. There is a problem with the

                  Payment Instrument being used which means that it
                  is unable to be used for the payment.
                  See below for recovery options.

Unspecified Unspecified error. There is some unknown problem

                  or error which does not fall into one of the other
                  CompletionCodes. The StatusDesc attribute should
                  provide the explanation of the cause.
                  See below for recovery options.

TimedOutRcvr Recoverable Time Out. Messages were resent but no

                  response received. The document exchange has
                  therefore "Timed Out". This code is only valid on
                  a Transaction Inquiry.
                  Recovery is possible if the last message from the
                  other Trading Role is received again.

TimedOutNoRcvr Non Recoverable Time Out. Messages were resent but

                  no response received. The document exchange has
                  therefore "Timed Out". This code is only valid on
                  a Transaction Inquiry.
                  No recovery possible.

If the Payment is Brand Independent, then recovery may be possible for some values of the Completion Code, by the Consumer selecting either a different payment brand or a different payment instrument for the same brand. Note that this might involve a different Payment Handler. The codes to which this applies are: BrandNotSupp, PaymtCancelled, InsuffFunds, InstBrandInvalid, InstNotValid, BadInstrument and Unspecified.

Recovery from Payments associated with Brand Dependent purchases is only possible, if the Brand Selection component sent by the Merchant to the Consumer does not change. In practice this means that the same Brand, Protocol Amount and PayProtocol elements must be used. All that can change is the Payment Instrument. Any other change will invalidate the Merchant's Offer as a changed selection will invalidate the Offer Response.

7.16.3 Delivery Completion Codes

The following table contains the valid values for the CompletionCode attribute for a Delivery. It is recommended that the StatusDesc attribute is used to provide further explanation where appropriate.

    Value                           Description

BackOrdered Back Ordered. The goods to be delivered are on order

               but they have not yet been received. Shipping will be
               arranged when they are received. This is only valid
               if ProcessState is CompletedOk.
               Recovery is not possible.

PermNotAvail Permanently Not Available. The goods are permanently

               unavailable and cannot be re-ordered. This is only
               valid if ProcessState is Failed.
               Recovery is not possible.

TempNotAvail Temporarily Not Available. The goods are temporarily

               unavailable and may become available if they can be
               ordered. This is only valid if ProcessState is
               CompletedOk.
               Recovery is not possible.

ShipPending Shipping Pending. The goods are available and are

               scheduled for shipping but they have not yet been
               shipped. This is only valid if ProcessState is
               CompletedOk.
               Recovery is not possible.

Shipped Goods Shipped. The goods have been shipped.

               Confirmation of delivery is awaited. This is only
               valid if ProcessState is CompletedOk.
               Recovery is not possible.

ShippedNoConf Shipped - No Delivery Confirmation. The goods have

               been shipped but it is not possible to confirm
               delivery of the goods. This is only valid if
               ProcessState is CompletedOk.
               Recovery is not possible.

ConsCancelled Consumer Cancelled. The Consumer decides to cancel

               the delivery for some reason. This code is only valid
               in a Status Component contained in a Cancel Block or
               an Inquiry Response Block.
               Recovery is not possible.

DelivCancelled Delivery Cancelled. The Delivery Handler declines to

               complete the Delivery for some reason and cancels the
               transaction. This code is only valid in a Status
               Component contained in a Cancel Block or an Inquiry
               Response Block.
               Recovery is not possible.

Confirmed Confirmed. All goods have been delivered and

               confirmation of their delivery has been received.
               This is only valid if ProcessState is CompletedOk.
               Recovery is not possible.

Unspecified Unspecified error. There is some unknown problem or

               error which does not fall into one of the other
               CompletionCodes. The StatusDesc attribute should
               provide the explanation of the cause.
               Recovery is not possible.

TimedOutRcvr Recoverable Time Out. Messages were resent but no

               response received. The document exchange has
               therefore "Timed Out". This code is only valid on a
               Transaction Inquiry.
               Recovery is possible if the last message from the
               other Trading Role is received again.

TimedOutNoRcvr Non Recoverable Time Out. Messages were resent but no

               response received. The document exchange has
               therefore "Timed Out". This code is only valid on a
               Transaction Inquiry.
               No recovery possible.

Note: Recovery from failed, or partially completed deliveries is not possible. The Consumer should use the Transaction Status Inquiry Transaction (see section 9.2.1) to determine up-to- date information on the current state.

7.16.4 Authentication Completion Codes

The Completion Code is only required if the ProcessState attribute is set to Failed. The following table contains the valid values for the CompletionCode that may be used. It is recommended that the StatusDesc attribute is used to provide further explanation where appropriate.

    Value                           Description

AutEeCancel Authenticatee Cancel. The Organisation being

               authenticated declines to be authenticated for some
               reason. This could be, for example because the
               signature on an Authentication Request was invalid or
               the Authenticator was not known or acceptable to the
               Authenticatee.
               Recovery is not possible.

AutOrCancel Authenticator Cancel. The Organisation requesting

               authentication declines to validate the
               Authentication Response received for some reason and
               cancels the transaction.
               Recovery is not possible.

NoAuthReq Authentication Request Not Available. The

               Authenticatee does not have the data that must be
               provided so that they may be successfully
               authenticated. For example a password may have been
               forgotten, the Authenticatee has not yet become a
               member, or a smart card token is not present.
               Recovery is not possible

AuthFailed Authentication Failed. The Authenticator checked the

               Authentication Response but the authentication failed
               for some reason. For example a password may have been
               incorrect.
               Recovery may be possible by the Authenticatee re-
               sending a revised Authentication Response with
               corrected data.

TradRolesIncon Trading Roles Inconsistent. The Trading Roles

               contained within the TradingRoleList attribute of the
               Trading Role Information Request Component (see
               section 7.4) are inconsistent with the Trading Role
               which the Authenticatee is taking in the IOTP
               Transaction or is able to take. Examples of
               inconsistencies include:
                o asking a PaymentHandler for DeliveryHandler
                 information
                o asking a Consumer for Merchant information
               Recovery may be possible by the Authenticator re-
               sending a revised Authentication Request Block with
               corrected information.

Unspecified Unspecified error. There is some unknown problem or

               error which does not fall into one of the other
               CompletionCodes.
               Recovery is not possible.

TimedOutRcvr Recoverable Time Out. Messages were resent but no

               response received. The document exchange has
               therefore "Timed Out". This code is only valid on a
               Transaction Inquiry.
               Recovery is possible if the last message from the
               other Trading Role is received again.

TimedOutNoRcvr Non Recoverable Time Out. Messages were resent but no

               response received. The document exchange has
               therefore "Timed Out". This code is only valid on a
               Transaction Inquiry.
               No recovery possible.

7.16.5 Undefined Completion Codes

The Completion Code is only required if the ProcessState attribute is set to Failed. The following table contains the valid values for the CompletionCode that may be used. It is recommended that the StatusDesc attribute is used to provide further explanation where appropriate.

    Value                           Description

InMsgHardError Input Message Hard Error. The type of Request Block

               could not be identified or was inconsistent.
               Therefore no single Document Exchange could be
               identified. This will cause a Hard Error in the
               transaction

7.16.6 Transaction Inquiry Completion Codes

The Completion Code is only required if the ProcessState attribute is set to Failed. The following table contains the valid values for the CompletionCode that may be used. It is recommended that the StatusDesc attribute is used to provide further explanation where appropriate.

    Value                           Description

UnAuthReq Unauthorised Request. The recipient of the

               Transaction Status Request declines to respond to the
               request.

7.17 Trading Role Data Component

The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque data which needs to be communicated between the Trading Roles involved in an IOTP Transaction.

Trading Role Components identify:

o the Organisation that generated the component, and

o the Organisation that is to receive it.

They are first generated and included in a "Response" Block, and then copied to the appropriate "Request" Block. For example a Payment Handler might need to inform a Delivery Handler that a credit card payment had been authorised but not captured. There may also be other information that the Payment Handler has generated where the format is privately agreed with the Delivery Handler which needs to be communicated. In another example a Merchant might need to provide a Payment Handler with some specific information about a Consumer so that consumer can acquire double loyalty points with the payment.

Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT TradingRoleData (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST TradingRoleData

 ID                ID      #REQUIRED
 OriginatorElRef   NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
 DestinationElRefs NMTOKENS #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Trading Role Data Component within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

OrginatorElRef Contains an element reference to the Organisation

                  Component of the Organisation that created the
                  Trading Role Data Component and included it in a
                  "Response" Block (e.g., an Offer Response or a
                  Payment Response Block).

DestinationElRefs Contains element references to the Organisation

                  Components of the Organisations that are to
                  receive the Trading Role Data Component in a
                  "Request" Block (e.g., either a Payment Request or
                  a Delivery Request Block).

Content:

PackagedContent This contains the data which is to be sent between

                  the various Trading Roles as one or more
                  PackagedContent elements see section 3.7.

7.17.1 Who Receives a Trading Role Data Component

The rules for deciding what to do with Trading Role Data Components are described below.

o whenever a Trading Role Data Component is received in a "Response"

  block identify the Organisation Components of the Organisations
  that are to receive it as identified by the DestinationElRefs
  attribute.

o whenever a "Request" Block is being sent, check to see if it is

  being sent to one of the Organisations identified by the
  DestinationElRefs attribute. If it is then include in the
  "Request" block:
  -  the Trading Role Data Component as well as,
  -  the Organisation Component of the Organisation identified by
     the OriginatorElRef attribute (if not already present)

7.18 Inquiry Type Component

The Inquiry Type Component contains the information which indicates the type of process that is being inquired upon. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT InquiryType EMPTY > <!ATTLIST InquiryType

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
Type               NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ElRef              NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessReference   CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Inquiry Type Component within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Type Contains the type of inquiry. Valid values for

                  Type are:
                   o Offer. The inquiry is about the status of an
                     offer and is addressed to the Merchant.
                   o Payment. The inquiry is about the status of a
                     payment and is addressed to the Payment
                     Handler.
                   o Delivery. The inquiry is about the status of a
                     delivery and addressed to the Delivery Handler.

ElRef Contains an Element Reference (see section 3.5) to

                  the component to which this Inquiry Type Component
                  applies. That is,
                   o TPO Block when Type is Offer
                   o Payment Component when Type is Payment
                   o Delivery Component when Type is Delivery

ProcessReference Optionally contains a reference to the process

                  being inquired upon. It should be set if the
                  information is available. For the definition of
                  the values it may contain, see the
                  ProcessReference attribute of the Status Component
                  (see section 7.16).

7.19 Signature Component

Note: Definitions of the XML structures for signatures and certificates are described in the document titled "Digital Signatures for the Internet Open Trading Protocol" by Kent Davidson and Yoshiaki Kawatsura published at the same time as this document - see [IOTPDSIG].

In the future it is anticipated that future versions of IOTP will adopt a whatever method for digitally signing XML becomes the standard.

Each Signature Component digitally signs one or more Blocks or Components including other Signature Components.

The Signature Component:

o contains digests of one or more Blocks or Components in one or

  more IOTP Messages within the same IOTP Transaction and places the
  result in a Digest Element

o concatenates these Digest elements with other information on the

  type of signature, the originator and potential recipients of the
  signature and details of the signature algorithms being used and
  places them in a Manifest element, and

o signs the Manifest element using the optional certificate

  identified in the Certificate element within the Signature Block
  placing the result in a Value element within a Signature Component

Note that there may be multiple Value elements that contain signatures of a Manifest Element.

A Signature Component can be one of four types either:

o an Offer Response Signature,

o a Payment Response Signature,

o a Delivery Response Signature, or

o an Authentication Response Signature.

For a general explanation of signatures see section 6 Digital Signatures.

7.19.1 IOTP usage of signature elements and attributes

Definitions of the elements and attributes are contained in [IOTPDSIG]. The following contains additional information that describes how these elements and attributes are used by IOTP.

SIGNATURE ELEMENT

The ID attribute is mandatory.

MANIFEST ELEMENT

The optional LocatorHrefBase attribute contains text which should be concatenated before the text contained in the LocatorHREF attribute of all Digest elements within the Manifest.

Its purpose is to reduce the size of LocatorHREF attribute values since the first part of the LocatorHREF attributes in the same signature are likely to be the same.

Typically, within IOTP, it will contain all the characters in a LocatorHref attribute up to the sharp ("#") character (see immediately below).

ALGORITHM AND PARAMETER ELEMENTS

The algorithm element identifies the algorithms used in generating the signature. The type of the algorithm is defined by the value of the Type attribute which indicates if it is to be used as a Digest algorithm, a Signature algorithm or a Key Agreement algorithm.

The following Digest algorithms must be implemented:

o a [DOM-HASH] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name

  attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:ibm:dom-hash"

o a [SHA1] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name

  attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:fips:sha1", and

o a [MD5] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name

  attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:rsa:md5"

o The following Signature algorithms must be implemented:

o a [DSA] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name

  attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:us.gov:dsa"

o a [HMAC] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name

  attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:ibm:hmac"

It is recommended that the following Signature algorithm is also implemented:

o a [RSA] algorithm. This is identified by setting the Name

  attribute of the Algorithm element to "urn:rsa:rsa"

In addition other payment scheme specific algorithms may be used. In this case the value of the name attribute to use is specified in the payment scheme supplement for that algorithm.

One algorithm may make use of other algorithms by use of the Parameter element, for example:

<Algorithm ID=A1 type="digest" name="urn:ibm:dom-hash">

 <Parameter type='AlgorithmRef'>A2</Parameter>

</Algorithm> <Algorithm ID=A2 type="digest" name="urn:fips:sha1"> </Algorithm> <Algorithm ID=A3 type="signature" name="urn:ibm:hmac">

   <Parameter type='AlgorithmRef'>A1</Parameter>

</Algorithm>

DIGEST ELEMENT

The LocatorHREF attribute identifies the IOTP element which is being digitally signed. Specifically it consists of:

o the value of the IotpTransId attribute of the Transaction ID

  Component, followed by:

o a sharp character, i.e. "#", followed by

o an Element Reference (see section 3.5) to the element within the

  IOTP Transaction which is the subject of the digest.

Before analysing the structure of the LocatorHREF attribute, it must be concatenated with the value of the LocatorHrefBase attribute of the Manifest element (see immediately above).

ATTRIBUTE ELEMENT

There must be one and only one Attribute Element that contains a Type attribute with a value of IOTP Signature Type and with content set to either: OfferResponse, PaymentResponse, DeliveryResponse,

AuthenticationRequest, AuthenticationResponse, PingRequest or PingResponse; depending on the type of the signature.

Values of the content of the Attribute element are controlled under the procedures defined in section 12 IANA Considerations which also allows user defined values to be defined.

The Critical attribute must be set to true.

ORIGINATORINFO ELEMENT

The OriginatorRef attribute of the OriginatorInfo element must always be present and contain an Element Reference (see section 3.5) to the Organisation Component of the Organisation that generated the Signature Component.

RECIPIENTINFO ELEMENT

The RecipientRefs attribute contains a list of Element References (see section 3.5), that point to the Organisations that might need to validate the signature. For details see below.

7.19.2 Offer Response Signature Component

The Manifest Element of a signature which has a type of OfferResponse should contain Digest elements for the following Components:

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP

  message that contains the Offer Response Signature

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the IOTP

  Message that contains the Offer Response Signature

o from the TPO Block:

  -  the Protocol Options Component
  -  each of the Organisation Components
  -  each of the Brand List Components

o optionally, all the Brand Selection Components if they were sent

  to the Merchant in a TPO Selection Block

o from the Offer Response Block:

  - the Order Component
  - each of the Payment Components
  - the Delivery Component
  - each of the Authentication Request Components
  - any Trading Role Data Components

The Offer Response Signature should also contain Digest elements for the components that describe each of the Organisations that may or will need to verify the signature. This involves:

o if the Merchant has received a TPO Selection Block containing

  Brand Selection Components, then generate a Digest element for the
  Payment Handler identified by the Brand Selection Component and
  the Delivery Handler identified by the Delivery Component. See
  section 6.3.1 Check Request Block sent Correct Organisation for a
  description of how this can be done.

o if the Merchant is not expecting to receive a TPO Selection Block

  then generate a Digest element for the Delivery Handler and all
  the Payment Handlers that are involved.

7.19.3 Payment Receipt Signature Component

The Manifest Element of the Payment Receipt Signature Component should contain Digest Elements for the following Components:

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP

  message that contains the Payment Receipt Signature

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the IOTP

  Message that contains the Payment Receipt Signature

o the Offer Response Signature Component

o the Payment Receipt Component

o the Payment Note Component

o the Status Component

o the Brand Selection Component.

o any Trading Role Data Components

7.19.4 Delivery Response Signature Component

The Manifest Element of the Delivery Response Signature Component should contain Digest Elements for the following Components:

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP

  message that contains the Delivery  Response Signature

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the IOTP

  Message that contains the Delivery Response Signature

o the Consumer Delivery Data component contained in the preceding

  Delivery Request (if any)

o the Signature Components contained in the preceding Delivery

  Request (if any)

o the Status Component

o the Delivery Note Component

7.19.5 Authentication Request Signature Component

The Manifest Element of the Authentication Request Signature Component should contain Digest Elements for the following Components:

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP

  Message that contains information that describes the IOTP Message
  and IOTP Transaction

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally

  uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction

o the following components of the TPO Block :

  -  the Protocol Options Component
  -  the Organisation Component

o the following components of the Authentication Request Block:

  -  the Authentication Request Component(s) (if present)
  -  the Trading Role Information Request Component (if present)

7.19.6 Authentication Response Signature Component

The Manifest Element of the Authentication Response Signature Component should contain Digest Elements for the following Components:

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP

  Message that contains information that describes the IOTP Message
  and IOTP Transaction

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally

  uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction

o the following components of the Authentication Request Block:

  -  the Authentication Request Component that was used in the
     Authentication (if present)
  -  the Trading Role Information Request Component (if present)

o the Organisation Components contained in the Authentication

  Response Block

7.19.7 Inquiry Request Signature Component

If the Inquiry Request is being signed (see section 9.2.1) the Manifest Element of the Inquiry Request Signature Component should contain Digest elements of the Inquiry Type Component, and if present, the Payment Scheme Component.

7.19.8 Inquiry Response Signature Component

If the Inquiry Response is being signed (see section 9.2.1) the Manifest Element of the Inquiry Response Signature Component should contain Digest elements of the Trading Response Block and the Status Component.

7.19.9 Ping Request Signature Component

If the Ping Request is being singed (see section 9.2.2), the Manifest Element of the Ping Request Signature Component should contain Digest elements for all the Organisation Components.

7.19.10 Ping Response Signature Component

If the Ping Response is being singed (see section 9.2.2), the Manifest Element of the Ping Response Signature Component should contain Digest elements fir all the Organisation Components.

7.20 Certificate Component

Note: Definitions of the XML structures for signatures and certificates are described in the paper "Digital Signatures for the Internet Open Trading Protocol", see [IOTPDSIG].

See note at the start of section 7.19 Signature Component for more details.

A Certificate Component contains a Digital Certificate. They are used only when required, for example, when asymmetric cryptography is being used and the recipient of the signature that needs to check has not already received the Public Key.

The structure of a Certificate Component is defined in [IOTPDSIG].

7.20.1 IOTP usage of signature elements and attributes

Detailed definitions of the above elements and attributes are contained in [IOTPDSIG]. The following contains additional information that describes how these elements and attributes are used by IOTP.

CERTIFICATE COMPONENT

The ID attribute is mandatory.

VALUE ELEMENT

The ID attribute is mandatory.

7.21 Error Component

The Error Component contains information about Technical Errors (see section 4.1) in an IOTP Message which has been received by one of the Trading Roles involved in the trade.

For clarity two phrases are defined which are used in the description of an Error Component:

o message in error. An IOTP message which contains or causes an

  error of some kind

o message reporting the error. An IOTP message that contains an

  Error Component that describes the error found in a message in
  error.

The definition of the Error Component is as follows.

<!ELEMENT ErrorComp (ErrorLocation+, PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST ErrorComp

ID                 NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ErrorCode          NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ErrorDesc          CDATA   #REQUIRED
Severity (Warning|TransientError|HardError) #REQUIRED
MinRetrySecs       CDATA   #IMPLIED
SwVendorErrorRef   CDATA   #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Error

                  Component within the IOTP Transaction.

xml:lang Defines the language used by attributes or child

                  elements within this component, unless overridden
                  by an xml:lang attribute on a child element. See
                  section 3.8 Identifying Languages.

ErrorCode Contains an error code which indicates the nature

                  of the error in the message in error. Valid values
                  for the ErrorCode are given in section 7.21.2
                  Error Codes.

ErrorDesc Contains a narrative description of the error in

                  the language defined by xml:lang. The content of
                  this attribute is defined by the vendor/developer
                  of the software which generated the Error
                  Component

Severity Indicates the severity of the error. Valid values

                  are:
                   o Warning. This indicates that although there is
                     a message in error the IOTP Transaction can
                     still continue.
                   o TransientError. This indicates that the error
                     in the message in error may be recovered if the
                     message in error  that is referred to by the
                     ErrorLocation element is resent
                   o HardError. This indicates that there is an
                     unrecoverable error in the message in error and
                     the IOTP Transaction must stop.

MinRetrySecs This attribute should be present if Severity is

                  set to TransientError. It is the minimum number of
                  whole seconds which the IOTP aware application
                  which received the message reporting the error
                  should wait before re-sending the message in error
                  identified by the ErrorLocation element.
                  If Severity is not set to TransientError then the
                  value of this attribute is ignored.

SwVendorErrorRef This attribute is a reference whose value is set

                  by the vendor/developer of the software which
                  generated the Error Component. It should contain
                  data which enables the vendor to identify the
                  precise location in their software and the set of
                  circumstances which caused the software to
                  generate a message reporting the error. See also
                  the SoftwareId attribute of the Message Id element
                  in the Transaction Reference Block (section 3.3).

Content:

ErrorLocation This identifies the IOTP Transaction Id of the

                  message in error  and, where possible, the element
                  and attribute in the message in error that caused
                  the Error Component to be generated.
                  If the Severity of the error is not
                  TransientError, more than one ErrorLocation may be
                  specified as appropriate depending on the nature
                  of the error (see section 7.21.2 Error Codes) and
                  at the discretion of  the vendor/developer of the
                  IOTP Aware Application.

PackagedContent This contains additional data which can be used to

                  understand the error. Its content may vary as
                  appropriate depending on the nature of the error
                  (see section 7.21.2 Error Codes) and at the
                  discretion of the vendor/developer of the IOTP
                  Aware Application. For a definition of
                  PackagedContent see section 3.7.

7.21.1 Error Processing Guidelines

If there is more than one Error Component in a message reporting the error, carry out the actions appropriate for the Error Component with the highest severity. In this context, HardError has a higher severity than TransientError, which has a higher severity than Warning.

7.21.1.1 Severity - Warning

If an IOTP aware application is generating a message reporting the error with an Error Component where the Severity attribute is set to Warning, then if the message reporting the error does not contain another Error Component with a severity higher than Warning, the IOTP Message must also include the Trading Blocks and Trading Components that would have been included if no error was being reported.

If a message reporting the error is received with an Error Component where Severity is set to Warning, then:

o it is recommended that information about the error is either

  logged, or otherwise reported to the user,

o the implementer of the IOTP aware application must either, at

  their or the user's discretion:
  -  continue the IOTP transaction as normal, or
  -  fail the IOTP transaction by generating a message reporting the
     error with an Error Component with Severity set to HardError
     (see section 7.21.1.3).

If the intention is to continue the IOTP transaction then, if there are no other Error Components with a higher severity, check that the necessary Trading Blocks and Trading Components for normal processing of the transaction to continue are present. If they are not then generate a message reporting the error with an Error Component with Severity set to HardError.

7.21.1.2 Severity - Transient Error

If an IOTP Aware Application is generating a message reporting the error with an Error Component where the Severity attribute is set to TransientError, then there should be only one Error Component in the message reporting the error. In addition, the MinRetrySecs attribute should be present.

If a message reporting the error is received with an Error Component where Severity is set to TransientError then:

o if the MinRetrySecs attribute is present and a valid number, then

  use the MinRetrySecs value given. Otherwise if MinRetrySecs is
  missing or is invalid, then:
  -  generate a message reporting the error containing an Error
     Component with a Severity of Warning and send it on the next
     IOTP message (if any) to be sent to the Trading Role which sent
     the message reporting the error with the invalid MinRetrySecs,
     and
  -  use a value for MinRetrySecs which is set by the
     vendor/developer of the IOTP Aware Application.

o check that only one ErrorLocation element is contained within the

  Error Component and that it refers to an IOTP Message which was
  sent by the recipient of the Error Component with a Severity of
  TransientError. If more than one ErrorLocation is present then
  generate a message reporting the error with a Severity of
  HardError.

7.21.1.3 Severity - Hard Error

If an IOTP Aware Application is generating a message reporting the error with an Error Component where the Severity attribute set to HardError, then there should be only one Error Component in the message reporting the error.

If a message reporting the error is received with an Error Component where Severity is set to HardError then terminate the IOTP Transaction.

7.21.2 Error Codes

The following table contains the valid values for the ErrorCode attribute of the Error Component. The first sentence of the description contains the text that should be used to describe the error when displayed or otherwise reported. Individual implementations may translate this into alternative languages at their discretion.

An Error Code must not be more that 14 characters long.

    Value                           Description

Reserved Reserved. This error is reserved by the

               vendor/developer of the software. Contact the
               vendor/developer of the software for more information
               See the SoftwareId attribute of the Message Id
               element in the Transaction Reference Block(section
               3.3).

XmlNotWellFrmd XML not well formed. The XML document is not well

               formed. See [XML] for the meaning of "well formed".
               Even if the XML is not well formed, it should still
               be scanned to find the Transaction Reference Block so
               that a properly formed Error Response may be
               generated.

XmlNotValid XML not valid. The XML document is well formed but

               the document is not valid. See [XML] for the meaning
               of "valid". Specifically:
                o the XML document does not comply with the
                 constraints defined in the IOTP document type
                 declaration (DTD) (see section 13 Internet Open
                 Trading Protocol Data Type Definition), and
                o the XML document does not comply with the
                 constraints defined in the document type
                 declaration of any additional [XML Namespace] that
                 are declared.
               As for XML not well formed, attempts should still be
               made to extract the Transaction Reference Block so
               that a properly formed Error Response may be
               generated.

ElUnexpected Unexpected element. Although the XML document is well

               formed and valid, an element is present that is not
               expected in the particular context according to the
               rules and constraints contained in this
               specification.

ElNotSupp Element not supported. Although the document is well

               formed and valid, an element is present that:
                o is consistent with the rules and constraints
                 contained in this specification, but
                o is not supported by the IOTP Aware Application
                 which is processing the IOTP Message.

ElMissing Element missing. Although the document is well formed

               and valid, an element is missing that should have
               been present if the rules and constraints contained
               in this specification are followed.
               In this case set the PackagedContent of the Error
               Component to the type of the missing element.

ElContIllegal Element content illegal. Although the document is

               well formed and valid, the element Content contains
               values which do not conform to the rules and
               constraints contained in this specification.

EncapProtErr Encapsulated protocol error. Although the document is

               well formed and valid, the PackagedContent of an
               element contains data from an encapsulated protocol
               which contains errors.

AttUnexpected Unexpected attribute. Although the XML document is

               well formed and valid, the presence of the attribute
               is not expected in the particular context according
               to the rules and constraints contained in this
               specification.

AttNotSupp Attribute not supported. Although the XML document is

               well formed and valid, and the presence of the
               attribute in an element is consistent with the rules
               and constraints contained in this specification, it
               is not supported by the IOTP Aware Application which
               is processing the IOTP Message.

AttMissing Attribute missing. Although the document is well

               formed and valid, an attribute is missing that should
               have been present if the rules and constraints
               contained in this specification are followed.
               In this case set the PackagedContent of the Error
               Component to the type of the missing attribute.

AttValIllegal Attribute value illegal. The attribute contains a

               value which does not conform to the rules and
               constraints contained in this specification.

AttValNotRecog Attribute Value Not Recognised. The attribute

               contains a value which the IOTP Aware Application
               generating the message reporting the error could not
               recognise.

MsgTooLarge Message too large. The message is too large to be

               processed by the IOTP Aware Application.

ElTooLarge Element too large. The element is too large to be

               processed by the IOTP Aware Application

ValueTooSmall Value too small or early. The value of all or part of

               the Content of an element or an attribute, although
               valid, is too small.

ValueTooLarge Value too large or in the future. The value of all or

               part of the Content of an element or an attribute,
               although valid, is too large.

ElInconsistent Element Inconsistent. Although the document is well

               formed and valid, according to the rules and
               constraints contained in this specification:
                o the content of an element is inconsistent with the
                 content of other elements or their attributes, or
                o the value of an attribute is inconsistent with the
                 value of one or more other attributes.
               In this case create ErrorLocation elements which
               identify all the attributes or elements which are
               inconsistent.

TransportError Transport Error. This error code is used to indicate

               that there is a problem with the Transport Mechanism
               which is preventing the message from being received.
               It is typically associated with a Transient Error.
               Explanation of the Transport Error is contained
               within the ErrorDesc attribute. The values which can
               be used inside ErrorDesc with a TransportError is
               specified in the IOTP supplement for the Transport
               mechanism.

MsgBeingProc Message Being Processed. This error code is only used

               with a Severity of Transient Error. It indicates that
               the previous message, which may be an exchange
               message or a request message, is being processed and,
               if no response is received by the time indicated by
               the MinRetrySecs attribute, then the original message
               should be resent.

SystemBusy System Busy. This error code is only used with a

               Severity of Transient Error. It indicates that the
               server that received a message is currently too busy
               to handle the message. If no response is received by
               the time indicated by the MinRetrySecs attribute,
               then the original message should be resent.

Note: If the server/system handling the Transport Mechanism (e.g., HTTP) is busy then a Transport Specific error message should be used instead of an IOTP Error message. This code should be used in association with IOTP servers/systems or other servers/systems to which the IOTP server is connected.

UnknownError Unknown Error. Indicates that the transaction cannot

               complete for some reason that is not covered
               explicitly by any of the other errors.  The ErrorDesc
               attribute should be used to indicate the nature of
               the problem.
               This could be used to indicate, for example, an
               internal error in a backend server or client process
               of some kind.

7.21.3 Error Location Element

An Error Location Element identifies an element and optionally an attribute in the message in error which is associated with the error. It contains a reference to the IOTP Message, Trading Block, Trading Component, element and attribute, which is in error.

<!ELEMENT ErrorLocation EMPTY > <!ATTLIST ErrorLocation

ElementType        NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
IotpMsgRef         NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
BlkRef             NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
CompRef            NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ElementRef         NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AttName            NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ElementType This is the name of the type of the element where

                  the error is located. For example if the element
                  was declared as <!ELEMENT Org ... then its name is
                  "Org".

IotpMsgRef This is the value of the ID attribute of the of

                  the Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2) of
                  the message in error to which this Error Component
                  applies.

BlkRef If the error is associated with a specific Trading

                  Block, then this is the value of the ID attribute
                  of the Trading Block where the error is located.

CompRef If the error is associated with a specific Trading

                  Component, then this is the value of the ID
                  attribute of the Trading Component where the error
                  is located.

ElementRef If the error is associated with a specific element

                  within a Trading Component then, if the element
                  has an attribute with an "attribute type" (see
                  [XML]) of "ID", then this is the value of that
                  attribute.

AttName If the error is associated with the value of an

                  attribute, then this is the name of that
                  attribute. In this case the PackagedContent of the
                  Error Component should contain the value of the
                  attribute.

Note that as many as the attributes as possible should be included. For example if an attribute in a child element of a Trading Component contains an incorrect value, then all the attributes of ErrorLocation should be present.

Trading Blocks

Trading Blocks are child elements of the top level IOTP Messages that are sent in the form of [XML] documents directly between the different Trading Roles that are taking part in a trade.

Each Trading Blocks consist of one or more Trading Components (see section 7). This is illustrated in the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
         IOTP MESSAGE  <-----------IOTP Message - an XML Document
          |                        which is transported between the
          |                        Trading Roles
          |-Trans Ref Block <----- Trans Ref Block - contains
          |  |                     information which describes the
          |  |                     IOTP Transaction and the IOTP
          |  |                     Message.
          |  |-Trans Id Comp. <--- Transaction Id Component -
          |  |                     uniquely identifies the IOTP
          |  |                     Transaction. The Trans Id
          |  |                     Components are the same across
          |  |                     all IOTP messages that comprise a
          |  |                     single IOTP transaction.
          |  |-Msg Id Comp. <----- Message Id Component - identifies
          |                        and describes an IOTP Message
          |                        within an IOTP Transaction
          |-Signature Block <----- Signature Block (optional) -
          |  |                     contains one or more Signature
          |  |                     Components and their associated
          |  |                     Certificates
          |  |-Signature Comp. <-- Signature Component - contains
          |  |                     digital signatures. Signatures
          |  |                     may sign digests of the Trans Ref
          |  |                     Block and any Trading Component
          |  |                     in any IOTP Message in the same
          |  |                     IOTP Transaction.
          |  |-Certificate Comp. <-Certificate Component. Used to
          |                        check the signature. (Optional)
  ------> |-Trading Block <--------Trading Block - an XML Element
 |        |  |-Trading Comp.       within an IOTP Message that

Trading | |-Trading Comp. contains a predefined set of Blocks | |-Trading Comp. Trading Components

 |        |  |-Trading Comp.
 |        |  |-Trading Comp. <-----Trading Components - XML Elements
 |        |                        within a Trading Block that
  ------> |-Trading Block          contain a predefined set of XML
          |  |-Trading Comp.       elements and attributes
          |  |-Trading Comp.       containing information required
          |  |-Trading Comp.       to support a Trading Exchange
          |  |-Trading Comp.
          |  |-Trading Comp.
          |
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                        Figure 16 Trading Blocks

Trading Blocks are defined as part of the definition of an IOTP Message (see section 3.1.1). The definition of an IOTP Message element is repeated here:

<!ELEMENT IotpMessage

  ( TransRefBlk,
    SigBlk?,
    ErrorBlk?,
    ( AuthReqBlk |
      AuthRespBlk |
      AuthStatusBlk |
      CancelBlk |
      DeliveryReqBlk |
      DeliveryRespBlk |
      InquiryReqBlk |
      InquiryRespBlk |
      OfferRespBlk |
      PayExchBlk |
      PayReqBlk |
      PayRespBlk |
      PingReqBlk |
      PingRespBlk |
      TpoBlk |
      TpoSelectionBlk
    )*
  ) >

The remainder of this section defines the Trading Blocks in this version of IOTP. They are:

o Authentication Request Block

o Authentication Response Block

o Authentication Status Block

o Cancel Block

o Delivery Request Block

o Delivery Response Block

o Error Block

o Inquiry Request Block

o Inquiry Response Block

o Offer Response Block

o Payment Exchange Block

o Payment Request Block

o Payment Response Block

o Signature Block

o Trading Protocol Options Block

o TPO Selection Block

The Transaction Reference Block is described in section 3.3.

Trading Protocol Options Block

The TPO Trading Block contains options which apply to the IOTP Transaction. The definition of a TPO Trading Block is as follows.

<!ELEMENT TpoBlk ( ProtocolOptions, BrandList*, Org* ) > <!ATTLIST TpoBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Trading Protocol Options Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction (see section 3.4 ID Attributes).

Content:

ProtocolOptions The Protocol Options Component (see section

                  7.1)defines the options which apply to the whole
                  IOTP Transaction (see section 9).

BrandList This Brand List Component contains one or more

                  payment brands and protocols which may be selected
                  (see section 7.7).

Org The Organisation Components (see section 7.6)

                  identify the Organisations and their roles in the
                  IOTP Transaction. The roles and Organisations
                  which must be present will depend on the
                  particular type of IOTP Transaction. See the
                  definition of each transaction in section 9.
                  Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions.

The TPO Block should contain:

o the Protocol Options Component

o the Organisation Component with the Trading Role of Merchant

o the Organisation Component with the Trading Role of Consumer

o optionally, the Organisation Component with the Trading Role of

  DeliverTo, if there is a Delivery included in the IOTP Transaction

o Brand List Components for each payment in the IOTP Transaction

o Organisation Components for all the Payment Handlers involved

o optionally, Organisation Components for the Delivery Handler (if

  any) for the transaction

o additional Organisation Components that the Merchant may want to

  include. For example
  -  a Customer Care Provider
  -  an Certificate Authority that offers Merchant "Credentials" or
     some other warranty on the goods or services being offered.

TPO Selection Block

The TPO Selection Block contains the results of selections made from the options contained in the Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 8.1).The definition of a TPO Selection Block is as follows.

<!ELEMENT TpoSelectionBlk (BrandSelection+) > <!ATTLIST TpoSelectionBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the TPO

                  Selection Block within the IOTP Transaction.

Content:

BrandSelection This identifies the choice of payment brand and

                  payment protocol to be used in a payment within
                  the IOTP Transaction. There is one Brand Selection
                  Component (see section 7.8) for each payment to be
                  made in the IOTP Transaction.

The TPO Selection Block should contain one Brand Selection Component for each Brand List in the TPO Block.

Offer Response Block

The Offer Response Block contains details of the goods, services, amount, delivery instructions or financial transaction which is to take place. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT OfferRespBlk (Status, Order?, Payment*,

            Delivery?, TradingRoleData*) >

<!ATTLIST OfferRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Offer

                  Response Block within the IOTP Transaction.

Content:

Status Contains status information about the business

                  success (see section 4.2) or failure of the
                  generation of the Offer. Note that in an Offer
                  Response Block, a ProcessState of NotYetStarted or
                  InProgress are illegal values.

Order The Order Component contains details about the

                  goods, services or financial transaction which is
                  taking place see section 7.5.
                  The Order Component must be present unless the
                  ProcessState attribute of the Status Component is
                  set to Failed.

Payment The Payment Components contain information about

                  the payments which are to be made see section 7.9.

Delivery The Delivery Component contains details of the

                  delivery to be made (see section 7.13).

TradingRoleData The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque

                  data which is needs to be communicated between the
                  Trading Roles involved in an IOTP Transaction (see
                  section 7.17).

The Offer Response Block should contain:

o the Order Component for the IOTP Transaction

o Payment Components for each Payment in the IOTP Transaction

o the Delivery Component the IOTP Transaction requires (if any).

Authentication Request Block

The Authentication Request Block contains the data which is used by one Trading Role to obtain information about and optionally authenticate another Trading Role.

In outline it contains:

o information about how the authentication itself will be carried

  out, and/or

o a request for additional information about the Organisation being

  authenticated.

Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT AuthReqBlk (AuthReq*, TradingRoleInfoReq?) > <!ATTLIST AuthReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Authentication Request Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Content:

AuthReq Each Authentication Request (see section 7.2)

                   component describes an alternative way in which
                   the recipient of the Authentication Request may
                   authenticate themselves by generating an
                   Authentication Response Component (see section
                   7.3).
                   If one Authentication Request Component is
                   present then that Authentication Request
                   Component should be used.
                   If more than one Authentication Request Component
                   is present then the recipient should choose one
                   of the components based on personal preference of
                   the recipient or their software.
                   If no Authentication Request Component is present
                   it means that the Authentication Request Block is
                   requesting the return of Organisation Components
                   as specified in the Trading Role Information
                   Request Component.

TradingRoleInfoReq The Trading Role Information Request Component

                   (see section 7.4) contains a list of Trading
                   Roles about which information is being requested

There must be at least one Component (either an Authentication Request or a Trading Role Information Request) within the Authentication Block otherwise it is an error.

Authentication Response Block

The Authentication Response Block contains the response which results from processing the Authentication Request Block. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT AuthRespBlk (AuthResp?, Org*) > <!ATTLIST AuthRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Authentication Response Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Content:

AuthResp The optional Authentication Response Component

                  which contains the results of processing the
                  Authentication Request Component - see section
                  7.3.

Org Optional Organisation Components that contain

                  information corresponding to the Trading Roles as
                  requested by the TradingRoleList attribute of the
                  Trading Role Information Request component.

The components present in the Authentication Response Block must match the requirement of the corresponding Authentication Request Block otherwise it is an error.

Authentication Status Block

The Authentication Status Block indicates the success or failure of the validation of an Authentication Response Block by an Authenticator. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT AuthStatusBlk (Status) > <!ATTLIST AuthStatusBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Authentication Status Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Content:

Status Contains status information about the business

                  success (see section 4.2) or failure of the
                  authentication

Payment Request Block

The Payment Request Block contains information which requests that a payment is started. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PayReqBlk (Status+, BrandList, BrandSelection,

    Payment, PaySchemeData?, Org*, TradingRoleData*) >

<!ATTLIST PayReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Payment Request Block within the IOTP Transaction.

Content:

Status Contains the Status Components (see section 7.13)

                  of the responses of the steps (e.g., an Offer
                  Response and/or a Payment Response) on which this
                  step depends. It is used to indicate the success
                  or failure of those steps. Payment should only
                  occur if the previous steps were successful.

BrandList The Brand List Component contains a list of one or

                  more payment brands and protocols which may be
                  selected (see section 7.7).

BrandSelection This identifies the choice of payment brand, the

                  payment protocol and the Payment Handler to be
                  used in a payment within the IOTP Transaction.
                  There is one Brand Selection Component (see
                  section 7.8) for each payment to be made in the
                  IOTP Transaction.

Payment The Payment Components contain information about

                  the payment which is being made see section 7.9.

PaySchemeData The Payment Scheme Component contains payment

                  scheme specific data see section 7.10.

Org The Organisation Component contains details of

                  Organisations involved in the payment (see section
                  7.6). The Organisations present are dependent on
                  the IOTP Transaction and the data which is to be
                  signed. See section 6 Digital Signatures for more
                  details.

TradingRoleData The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque

                  data which is needs to be communicated between the
                  Trading Roles involved in an IOTP Transaction (see
                  section 7.17).

The Payment Request Block should contain:

o the Organisation Component with a Trading Role of Merchant

o the Organisation Component with the Trading Role of Consumer

o the Payment Component for the Payment

o the Brand List Component for the Payment

o the Brand Selection Component for the Brand List

o the Organisation Component for the Payment Handler of the Payment

o the Organisation Component (if any) for the Organisation which

  carried out the previous step, for example another Payment Handler

o the Organisation Component for the Organisation which is to carry

  out the next step, if any. This may be, for example, either a
  Delivery Handler or a Payment Handler.

o the Organisation Components for any additional Organisations that

  the Merchant has included in the Offer Response Block

o an Optional Payment Scheme Data Component, if required by the

  Payment Method as defined in the IOTP supplement for the payment
  method

o any Trading Role Data Components that may be required (see section

  7.17.1).

Payment Exchange Block

The Payment Exchange Block contains payment scheme specific data which is exchanged between two of the roles in a trade. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PayExchBlk (PaySchemeData+) > <!ATTLIST PayExchBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Payment Exchange Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Content:

PaySchemeData This Trading Component contains payment scheme

                  specific data see section 7.10 Payment Scheme
                  Component.

Payment Response Block

This Payment Response Block contains a information about the Payment Status, an optional Payment Receipt, and an optional payment protocol message. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PayRespBlk (Status, PayReceipt?, PaySchemeData?,

    PaymentNote?, TradingRoleData*) >

<!ATTLIST PayRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Payment Response Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Content:

Status Contains status information about the business

                  success (see section 4.2) or failure of the
                  payment. Note that in a Pay Response Block, a
                  ProcessState of NotYetStarted or InProgress are
                  illegal values.

PayReceipt Contains payment scheme specific data which can be

                  used to verify the payment occurred. See section
                  7.11 Payment Receipt Component. It must be present
                  if the ProcessState attribute of the Status
                  Component is set to CompletedOk. PayReceipt is
                  optional for other values as specified by the
                  appropriate Payment Scheme supplement.

PaySchemeData Contains payment scheme specific data see section,

                  for example a payment protocol message. See 7.10
                  Payment Scheme Component.

PaymentNote Contains additional, non payment related,

                  information which the Payment Handler wants to
                  provide to the Consumer. For example, if a
                  withdrawal or deposit were being made then it
                  could contain information on the remaining balance
                  on the account after the transfer was complete.
                  See section 7.12 Payment Note Component.

TradingRoleData The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque

                  data which is needs to be communicated between the
                  Trading Roles involved in an IOTP Transaction (see
                  section 7.17).

8.10 Delivery Request Block

The Delivery Request Block contains details of the goods or services which are to be delivered together with a signature which can be used to check that delivery is authorised. Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT DeliveryReqBlk (Status+, Order, Org*, Delivery,

    ConsumerDeliveryData?, TradingRoleData*) >

<!ATTLIST DeliveryReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Delivery Request Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Content:

Status Contains the Status Components (see section

                     7.13) of the responses of the steps (e.g., a
                     Payment Response) on which this step is
                     dependent. It is used to indicate the success
                     or failure of those steps. Delivery should only
                     occur if the previous steps were successful.

Order The Order Component contains details about the

                     goods, services or financial transaction which
                     is taking place see section 7.5.
                     The Organisation Components (see section 7.6)
                     identify the Organisations and their roles in

Org the IOTP Transaction. The roles and

                     Organisations which must be present will depend
                     on the particular type of IOTP Transaction. See
                     the definition of each transaction in section
                     9. Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions.

Delivery The Delivery Component contains details of the

                     delivery to be made (see section 7.13).

ConsumerDeliveryData Optional. Contains an identifier specified by

                     the Consumer which, if returned by the Delivery
                     Handler will enable the Consumer to identify
                     which Delivery is being referred to.

TradingRoleData The Trading Role Data Component contains opaque

                     data which is needs to be communicated between
                     the Trading Roles involved in an IOTP
                     Transaction (see section 7.17).

The Delivery Request Block contains:

o the Organisation Component with a Trading Role of Merchant

o the Organisation Component for the Consumer and DeliverTo Trading

  Roles

o the Delivery Component for the Delivery

o the Organisation Component for the Delivery Handler. Specifically

  the Organisation Component identified by the ActionOrgRef
  attribute on the Delivery Component

o the Organisation Component (if any) for the Organisation which

  carried out the previous step, for example a Payment Handler

o the Organisation Components for any additional Organisations that

  the Merchant has included in the Offer Response Block

o any Trading Role Data Components that may be required (see section

  7.17.1).

8.11 Delivery Response Block

The Delivery Response Block contains a Delivery Note containing details on how the goods will be delivered. Its definition is as follows. Note that in a Delivery Response Block a Delivery Status Element with a DeliveryStatusCode of NotYetStarted or InProgress is invalid.

<!ELEMENT DeliveryRespBlk (Status, DeliveryNote) > <!ATTLIST DeliveryRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Delivery Response Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Content:

Status Contains status information about the business

                  success (see section 4.2) or failure of the
                  delivery.  Note that in a Delivery Response Block,
                  a ProcessState of NotYetStarted or InProgress are
                  illegal values.

DeliveryNote The Delivery Note Component contains details about

                  how the goods or services will be delivered (see
                  section 7.15).

8.12 Inquiry Request Trading Block

The Inquiry Request Trading Block contains an Inquiry Type Component and an optional Payment Scheme Component to contain payment scheme specific inquiry messages.

<!ELEMENT InquiryReqBlk ( InquiryType, PaySchemeData? ) > <!ATTLIST InquiryReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Inquiry Request Trading Block within the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Content:

InquiryType Inquiry Type Component (see section 7.18) that

                  contains the type of inquiry.

PaySchemeData Payment Scheme Component (see section 7.10) that

                  contains payment scheme specific inquiry messages
                  for inquiries on payments. This is present when
                  the Type attribute of Inquiry Type Component is
                  Payment.

8.13 Inquiry Response Trading Block

The Inquiry Response Trading Block contains a Status Component and an optional Payment Scheme Component to contain payment scheme specific inquiry messages. Its purpose is to enquire on the current status of an IOTP transaction at a server.

<!ELEMENT InquiryRespBlk (Status, PaySchemeData?) > <!ATTLIST InquiryRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
LastReceivedIotpMsgRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
LastSentIotpMsgRef  NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                       Inquiry Response Trading Block within the
                       IOTP Transaction.

LastReceivedIotpMsgRef Contains an Element Reference (see section

                       3.5) to the Message Id Component (see section
                       3.3.2) of the last message this server has
                       received from the Consumer. If there is no
                       previously received message from the Consumer
                       in the pertinent transaction, this attribute
                       should be contain the value Null. This
                       attribute exists for debugging purposes.

LastSentIotpMsgRef Contains an Element Reference (see section

                       3.5) to the Message Id Component (see section
                       3.3.2) of the last message this server has
                       sent to the Consumer. If there is no
                       previously sent message to the Consumer in
                       the pertinent transaction, this attribute
                       should contain the value Null. This attribute
                       exists for debugging purposes.

Content:

Status Contains status information about the business

                  success (see section 4.2) or failure of a certain
                  trading exchange (i.e., Offer, Payment, or
                  Delivery).

PaySchemeData Payment Scheme Component (see section 7.10) that

                  contains payment scheme specific inquiry messages
                  for inquiries on payments. This is present when
                  the Type attribute of StatusType attribute of the
                  Status Component is set to Payment.

8.14 Ping Request Block

The Ping Request Block is used to determine if a Server is operating and whether or not cryptography is compatible.

The definition of a Ping Request Block is as follows.

<!ELEMENT PingReqBlk (Org*)> <!ATTLIST PingReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED>

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Ping

                  Request Trading Block within the IOTP Transaction.

Content:

Org Optional Organisation Components (see section

                  7.6).
                  If no Organisation Component is present then the
                  Ping Request is anonymous and simply determines if
                  the server is operating.
                  However if Organisation Components are present,
                  then it indicates that the sender of the Ping
                  Request wants to verify that digital signatures
                  can be handled.
                  In this case the sender includes:
                   o an Organisation Component that identifies
                     itself specifying the Trading Role(s) it is
                     taking in IOTP transactions (Merchant, Payment
                     Handler, etc.)
                   o an Organisation Component that identifies the
                     intended recipient of the message.
                  These are then used to generate a signature over
                  the Ping Response Block.

8.15 Ping Response Block

The Ping Response Trading Block provides the result of a Ping Request.

It contains an Organisation Component that identifies the sender of the Ping Response.

If the Ping Request to which this block is a response contained Organisation Components, then it also contains those Organisation Components.

<!ELEMENT PingRespBlk (Org+)> <!ATTLIST PingRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
PingStatusCode (Ok | Busy | Down) #REQUIRED
SigVerifyStatusCode (Ok | NotSupported | Fail) #IMPLIED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
PingStatusDesc     CDATA   #IMPLIED>

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Ping

                    Request Trading Block within the IOTP
                    Transaction.

PingStatusCode Contains a code which shows the status of the

                    sender software which processes IOTP messages.
                    Valid values are:
                     o Ok. Everything with the service is working
                      normally, including the signature
                      verification.
                     o Busy. Things are working normally but there
                      may be some delays.
                     o Down. The server is not functioning fully but
                      can still provide a Ping response.

SigVerifyStatusCode Contains a code which shows the status of

                    signature verification. This is present only
                    when the message containing the Ping Request
                    Block also contains a Signature Block. Valid
                    values are:
                     o Ok. The signature has successfully been
                      verified and proved compatible.
                     o NotSupported The receiver of this Ping
                      Request Block does not support validation of
                      signatures.
                     o Fail. Signature verification failed.

Xml:lang Defines the language used in PingStatusDesc.

                    This is present when PingStatusDesc is present.

PingStatusDesc Contains a short description of the status of

                    the server which sends this Ping Response Block.
                    Servers, if their designers want, can use this
                    attribute to send more refined status
                    information than PingStatusCode which can be
                    used for debugging purposes, for example.

Content:

Org These are Organisation Components (see section

                  7.6).
                  The Organisation Components of the sender of the
                  Ping Response is always included in addition to
                  the Organisation Components sent in the Ping
                  Request.

Note: Ping Status Code values do not include a value such as Fail, since, when the software receiving the Ping Request message is not working at all, no Ping Response message will be sent back.

8.16 Signature Block

The Signature Block contains one or more Signature Components and associated Certificates (if required) which sign data associated with the IOTP Transaction. For a general discussion and introduction to how IOTP uses signatures, see section 6 Digital Signatures. The definition of the Signature Component and certificates is contained in the paper "Digital Signatures for the Internet Open Trading Protocol", see [IOTPDSIG]. Descriptions of how these are used by IOTP is contained in sections 7.19 and 7.20.

The definition of a Signature Block is as follows:

<!ELEMENT IotpSignatures (Signature+, Certificate*) > <!ATTLIST IotpSignatures

 ID                ID      #IMPLIED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the

                  Signature Block within the IOTP Transaction.

Content:

Signature A Signature Component. See section 7.19.

Certificate A Certificate Component. See section 7.20.

The contents of a Signature Block depends on the Trading Block that is contained in the same IOTP Message as the Signature Block.

8.16.1 Signature Block with Offer Response

A Signature Block which is in the same message as an Offer Response Block contains just an Offer Response Signature Component (see section 7.19.2).

8.16.2 Signature Block with Payment Request

A Signature Block which is in the same message as a Payment Request Block contains:

o an Offer Response Signature Component (see section 7.19.2), and

o if the Payment is dependent on an earlier step (as indicated by

  the StartAfter attribute on the Payment Component), then the
  Payment Receipt Signature Component (see section 7.19.3) generated
  by the previous step

8.16.3 Signature Block with Payment Response

  A Signature Block which is in the same message as a Payment
  Response Block contains just a Payment Receipt Signature Component
  (see section 7.19.3) generated by the step.

8.16.4 Signature Block with Delivery Request

  A Signature Block which is in the same message as a Delivery
  Request Block contains:

o an Offer Response Signature Component (see section 7.19.2), and

o the Payment Receipt Signature Component (see section 7.19.3)

  generated by the previous step.

8.16.5 Signature Block with Delivery Response

A Signature Block which is in the same message as a Delivery Response Block contains just a Delivery Response Signature component (see section 7.19.4) generated by the step.

8.17 Error Block

The Error Trading Block contains one or more Error Components (see section 7.21) which contain information about Technical Errors (see section 4.1) in an IOTP Message which has been received by one of the Trading Roles involved in the trade.

For clarity two phrases are defined which are used in the description of an Error Trading Block:

o message in error. An IOTP message which contains or causes an

  error of some kind

o message reporting the error. An IOTP message that contains an

  Error Trading Block that describes the error found in a message in
  error.

An Error Trading Block may be contained in any message reporting the error. The action which then follows depends on the severity of the error. See the definition of an Error Component, for an explanation of the different types of severity and the actions which can then occur.

in3 Note: Although, an Error Trading Block can report multiple different errors using multiple Error Components, there is no obligation on a developer of an IOTP Aware Application to do so.

The structure of an Error Trading Block is as follows.

<!ELEMENT ErrorBlk (ErrorComp+, PaySchemeData*) > <!ATTLIST ErrorBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Error

                  Trading Block within the IOTP Transaction.

Content:

ErrorComp An Error Components (see section 7.21) that

                  contains information about an individual Technical
                  Error.

PaySchemeData An optional Payment Scheme Component (see section

                  7.10) which contains a Payment Scheme Message. See
                  the appropriate payment scheme supplement to
                  determine whether or not this component needs to
                  be present and for the definition of what it must
                  contain.

8.18 Cancel Block

The Cancel Block is used by one Trading Role to inform any other that a transaction has been cancelled. Example usage includes:

o a Consumer Role informing a non-Consumer role that it no longer

  plans to continue with the transaction. This will allow the server
  to close down the transaction tidily without a waiting for a
  time-out to occur

o a non-Consumer Role to inform a Consumer role that the Transaction

  is being stopped. In this case, the Consumer is then unlikely to
  re-send the previous message that was sent in the mistaken
  understanding that the original was not received.

Its definition is as follows.

<!ELEMENT CancelBlk (Status) > <!ATTLIST CancelBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

Attributes:

ID An identifier which uniquely identifies the Cancel

                  Block within the IOTP Transaction.

Content:

Status Contains status information indicating that the

                  IOTP transaction has been cancelled.

Internet Open Trading Protocol Transactions

The Baseline Internet Open Trading Protocol supports three types of transactions for different purposes. These are

o an Authentication IOTP transaction which supports authentication

  of one party in a trade by another and/or requests information
  about another Trading Role

o IOTP Transactions that involve one or more payments. Specifically:

  -  Deposit
  -  Purchase
  -  Refund
  -  Withdrawal, and
  -  Value Exchange

o IOTP Transactions designed to check the correct function of the

  IOTP infrastructure. Specifically:
  -  Transaction Status Inquiry, and
  -  Ping

Although the Authentication IOTP Transaction can operate on its own, authentication can optionally precede any of the "payment" transactions. Therefore, the rest of this section is divided into two parts covering:

o Authentication and Payment transactions (Authentication, Deposit,

  Purchase, Refund, Withdrawal and Value Exchange)

o Infrastructure Transactions (Transaction Status Inquiry and Ping)

  that are designed to support inquiries on whether or not a
  transaction has succeeded or a Trading Role's servers are
  operating correctly, and

Authentication and Payment Related IOTP Transactions

  The Authentication and Payment related IOTP Transactions consist
  of six Document Exchanges which are then combined in sequence to
  implement a specific transaction.
  Generally, there is a close, but not exact, correspondence between
  a Document Exchange and a Trading Exchange. The main difference is
  that some Document Exchanges implement part or all of two Trading
  Exchanges simultaneously in order to minimise the number of actual
  IOTP Messages which must be sent over the Internet.
  The six Document Exchanges are:

o Authentication. This is a direct implementation of the

  Authentication Trading Exchange

o Brand Dependent Offer. This is the Offer Trading Exchange combined

  with the Brand Selection part of the Payment Trading Exchange. Its
  purpose is to provide the Merchant with information on the Brand
  selected so that the content of the Offer Response may be adapted
  accordingly

o Brand Independent Offer. This is also an Offer Trading Exchange.

  However, in this instance, the content of the Offer Response does
  not depend on the Brand selected.

o Payment. This is a direct implementation of the Payment part of a

  Payment Trading Exchange

o Delivery. This is a direct implementation of the Delivery Exchange

o Delivery with Payment. This is an implementation of combined

  Payment and Delivery Trading Exchanges

These Document Exchanges are combined together in different sequences to implement each IOTP Transaction. The way in which they may be combined is illustrated by the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
 START -----------------------------------------------------
  |                                                         v
  |                                                ----------------
  |                                               | AUTHENTICATION |
  |                                                ----------------
   --------------------------------------               |    |
                   |                     |              |    |
                   |      -------------- | -------------     |
                   v      v              v      v            |
              -------------------     -----------------      |
             | BRAND INDEPENDENT |   | BRAND DEPENDENT |     |
             |       OFFER       |   |      OFFER      |     |
              -------------------     -----------------      |
                    |    |                   |   |           |
                    |     ---------------    |   |           |
                    |                    |   |   |           |
                    |     -------------- | --    |           |
                    v    v               v       v           |
                  ---------           --------------         |
                 | PAYMENT |         | PAYMENT WITH |        |
                 | (first) |         |   DELIVERY   |        |
                  ---------           --------------         |
                      |                      |               |
          -----------------------------      |               |
          v                v           |     |               |
     ----------        ---------       |     |               |
    | DELIVERY |      | PAYMENT |      |     |               |
    |          |      | {second)|      |     |               |
     ----------        ---------       |     |               |
          |                |           |     |               v
           ----------------------------------------------> STOP
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
     Figure 17 Payment and Authentication Message Flow Combinations

The combinations of Document Exchanges that are valid depend on the particular IOTP transaction.

The remainder of this sub-section describes:

o each Document Exchange in more detail including descriptions of

  the content of each Trading Block in the Document Exchanges, and

o descriptions of how each IOTP Transaction uses the Document

  Exchanges to effect the desired result.

Note: The descriptions of the Document Exchanges which follow describe the ways in which various Business Errors (see section 4.2) are handled. No reference is made however to the handling of Technical Errors (see section 4.1) in any of the messages since these are handled the same way irrespective of the context in which the message is being sent. See section 4 for more details.

Authentication Document Exchange

The Authentication Document Exchange is a direct implementation of the Authentication Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.4). It involves:

o an Authenticator - the Organisation which is requesting the

  authentication, and

o an Authenticatee - the Organisation being authenticated.

The authentication consists of:

o an Authentication Request being sent by the Authenticator to the

  Authenticatee,

o an Authentication Response being sent in return by the

  Authenticatee to the Authenticator which is then checked, and

o an Authentication Status being sent by the Authenticator to the

  Authenticatee to provide an indication of the success or failure
  of the authentication.

An Authentication Document Exchange also:

o provides an Authenticatee with an Organisation Component which

  describes the Authenticator, and

o optionally provides the Authenticator with Organisation Components

  which describe the Authenticatee.

The Authentication Request may also be digitally signed which allows the Authenticatee to verify the credentials of the Authenticator.

The IOTP Messages which are involved are illustrated by the diagram below.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Organisation 1
(Authenticatee)
 |   Organisation 2
 |  (Authenticator)

STEP | |

1.          First Organisation takes an action (for example by
         pressing a button on an HTML page) which requires that
         the Organisation is authenticated
 1 --> 2 Authentication Need (outside scope of IOTP)
2.          The second Organisation generates: an Authentication
         Request Block containing one or more Authentication
         Request Components and/or a Trading Role Information
         Request Component, then sends it to the first
         Organisation
 1 <-- 2 TPO & AUTHENTICATION REQUEST. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block;
         Signature Block (optional); TPO Block; Auth Request Block
3.          IOTP aware application started. If a Signature Block is
         present, the first Organisation may use this to check the
         credentials of the second Organisation. If credentials are
         OK, the first Organisation selects an Authentication
         Request to use (if present and more than one), then uses
         the authentication algorithm selected to generate an
         Authentication Response Block. If present, the Trading
         Role Information Request Component is used to generate
         Organisation Components. Finally a Signature Component is
         created if required and all components are then sent back
         to the second Organisation for validation.
 1 --> 2 AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE. IotpMsg; Trans Ref Block;
         Signature Block (optional) ; Auth Response Block
4.          The second Organisation checks the Authentication
         Response against the data in the Authentication Request
         Block to check that the first Organisation is who they
         appear to be, and sends an Authentication Status Block to
         the first Organisation to indicate the result then
         stops.
 1 <-- 2 AUTHENTICATION STATUS. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block;
         Signature Block (optional); Auth Response Block
5.          The first Organisation checks the authentication Status
         Block and optionally keeps information on the IOTP
         transaction for record keeping purposes and stops.
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
             Figure 18 Authentication Document Exchange
Message Processing Guidelines

On receiving a TPO & Authentication Request IOTP Message (see below), an Authenticatee may either:

o generate and send an Authentication Response IOTP Message back to

  the Authenticator, or

o indicate failure to comply with the Authentication Request by

  sending a Cancel Block back to the Authenticator containing a
  Status Component with a StatusType of Authentication a
  ProcessState of Failed and the CompletionCode (see section 7.16.4)
  set to either: AutEeCancel, NoAuthReq, TradRolesIncon or
  Unspecified.

On receiving an Authentication Response IOTP Message (see below), an Authenticator should send in return, an Authentication Status IOTP Message (see below) containing a Status Block with a Status Component where the StatusType is set to Authentication, and:

o the ProcessState attribute of the Status Component is set to

  CompletedOk which indicates a successful completion, or

o the ProcessState attribute is set to Failed and the CompletionCode

  attribute is set to either: AutOrCancel, AuthFailed or Unspecified
  which indicates a failed authentication,

On receiving an Authentication Status IOTP Message (see below), the Authenticatee should check the Status Component in the Status Block. If this indicates:

o a successful authentication, then the Authenticatee should either:

  -  continue with the next step in the IOTP Transaction of which
     the Authentication Document Exchange is part (if any), or
  -  indicate a failure to continue with the rest of the IOTP
     Transaction, by sending back to the Authenticator a Cancel
     Block containing a Status Component with a StatusType of
     Authentication, a ProcessState of Failed and the CompletionCode
     (see section 7.16.4) set to AutEeCancel.

o a failed authentication, then the failure should be reported to

  the Authenticatee and any further processing stopped.

If the Authenticator receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block from a Consumer, then the Authenticatee may go to the CancelNetLocn specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component for the Authenticator contained in the Trading Protocol Options Block.

TPO & Authentication Request IOTP Message

Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of:

o a Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 8.1)

o an Authentication Request Block (see section 8.4), and

o an optional Signature Block (see section 8.16).

Each of these are described below.

TRADING PROTOCOL OPTIONS BLOCK

The Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 8.1) must contain the following Trading Components:

o one Protocol Options Component (see Section 7.1) which defines the

  options which apply to the whole Authentication Document Exchange.

o one Organisation Component (see section 7.6) which describes the

  Authenticator. The Trading Role on the Organisation Component
  should indicate the role which the Authenticator is taking in the
  Trade, for example a Merchant or a Consumer.

AUTHENTICATION REQUEST BLOCK

The Authentication Request Block (see section 8.4) must contain the following Trading Components:

o one Authentication Request Component (see section 7.2), and

SIGNATURE BLOCK (AUTHENTICATION REQUEST)

If the Authentication Request is being digitally signed then a Signature Block must be included. It contains Digests of the following XML elements:

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP

  Message that contains information that describes the IOTP Message
  and IOTP Transaction

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally

  uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction

o the following components of the TPO Block :

  -  the Protocol Options Component
  -  the Organisation Component

o the following components of the Authentication Request Block:

  -  the Authentication Request Component
  -  the Trading Role Information Request Component
Authentication Response IOTP Message

Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of:

o an Authentication Response Block (see section 8.5), and

o an optional Signature Block (see section 8.16).

Each of these are described below.

AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE BLOCK

The Authentication Response Block must contain the following Trading Component:

o one Authentication Response Component (see section 7.3)

o one Organisation Component for every Trading Role identified in

  the TradingRoleList attribute of the Trading Role Information
  Request Component contained in the Authentication Request Block.

SIGNATURE BLOCK (AUTHENTICATION RESPONSE)

If the Algorithm element (see section 12. IANA Considerations) within the Authentication Request Component contained in the Authentication Request Block indicates that the Authentication Response should consist of a digital signature then a Signature Block must be included in the same IOTP message that contains an Authentication Response Block. The Signature Component contains Digest Elements for the following XML elements:

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP

  Message that contains information that describes the IOTP Message
  and IOTP Transaction

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally

  uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction

o the following components of the Authentication Request Block:

  -  the Authentication Request Component
  -  the Trading Role Information Request Component

o the Organisation Components contained in the Authentication

  Response Block

Note: It should not be assumed that all trading roles can support the signing of data. Particularly it should not be assumed that Consumers support the signing of data.

Authentication Status IOTP Message

Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of:

o an Authentication Status Block (see section 8.5), and

o an optional Signature Block (see section 8.16).

Each of these are described below.

AUTHENTICATION STATUS BLOCK

The Authentication Status Block (see section 8.6) must contain the following Trading Components:

o one Status Component (see section 7.16) with a ProcessState

  attribute set to CompletedOk.
  SIGNATURE BLOCK (AUTHENTICATION STATUS)
  If the Authentication Status Block is being digitally signed then
  a Signature Block must be included that contains a Signature
  Component with Digest elements for the following XML elements:

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP

  Message that contains information that describes the IOTP Message
  and IOTP Transaction

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally

  uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction

o the following components of the Authentication Status Block:

  -  the Status Component (see section 7.16).

Note: If the Authentication Document Exchange is followed by an Offer Document Exchange (see section 9.1.2) then the Authentication Status Block and the Signature Block (Authentication Status) may be combined with either:

o a TPO IOTP Message (see section 9.1.2.3), or

o a TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message (see section 9.1.2.6)

Offer Document Exchange

The Offer Document Exchange occurs in two basic forms:

o Brand Dependent Offer Exchange. Where the content of the offer,

  e.g., the order details, amount, delivery details, etc., are
  dependent on the payment brand and protocol selected by the
  consumer, and

o Brand Independent Offer Exchange. Where the content of the offer

  is not dependent on the payment brand and protocol selected.
  Each of these types of Offer Document Exchange may be preceded by
  an Authentication Document Exchange (see section 9.1.1).
Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange
  In a Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange the TPO Block and the
  Offer Response Block are sent separately by the Merchant to the
  Consumer, i.e.:

o the Brand List Component is sent to the Consumer in a TPO Block,

o the Consumer selects a Payment Brand, Payment Protocol and

  optionally a Currency and amount from the Brand List Component

o the Consumer sends the selected brand, protocol and

  currency/amount back to the Merchant in a TPO Selection Block, and

o the Merchant uses the information received to define the content

  of and then send the Offer Response Block to the Consumer.
This is illustrated by the diagram below.
*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

Consumer

 |  Merchant

STEP | |

1.          Consumer decides to trade and sends to the Merchant
         information (e.g., using HTML) that enables the Merchant
         to create an offer,
 C --> M Offer information - outside scope of IOTP
2.          Merchant decides which payment brand protocols,
         currencies and amounts apply, places then in a Brand List
         Component inside a TPO Block and sends to Consumer
 C <-- M TPO. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; TPO Block
3.          IOTP aware application started. Consumer selects the
         payment brand, payment protocol and currency/amount to
         use. Records selection in a Brand Selection Component and
         sends back to Merchant.
 C --> M TPO SELECTION. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; TPO Selection
         Block
4.          Merchant uses selected payment brand, payment protocol,
         currency/amount and the offer information to create an
         Offer Response Block containing details about the IOTP
         Transaction including price, etc. Optionally signs it and
         sends to the Consumer
 C <-- M OFFER RESPONSE. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Signature Block
         (optional); Offer Response Block
5.          Consumer checks the Offer is OK, then combines components
         from the TPO Block, the TPO Selection Block and the Offer
         Response Block to create the next IOTP Message for the
         Transaction and sends it together with the Signature
         block if present to the required Trading Role
 CONTINUED ...
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
          Figure 19 Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange

Note, a Consumer identifies a Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange, by the absence of an Offer Response Block in the first IOTP Message.

MESSAGE PROCESSING GUIDELINES

On receiving a TPO IOTP Message (see below), the Consumer may either:

o generate and send a TPO Selection IOTP Message back to the

  Merchant, or

o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by sending

  a Cancel Block back to the Merchant containing a Status Component
  with a StatusType of Offer, a ProcessState of Failed and the
  CompletionCode (see section 7.16.4) set to either: ConsCancelled
  or Unspecified.

On receiving a TPO Selection IOTP Message (see below) the Merchant may either:

o generate and send an Offer Response IOTP Message back to the

  Consumer, or

o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by sending

  a Cancel Block back to the Consumer containing a Status Component
  with a StatusType of Offer, a ProcessState of Failed and the
  CompletionCode (see section 7.16.4) set to either: MerchCancelled
  or Unspecified.

On receiving an Offer Response IOTP Message (see below) the Consumer may either:

o generate and send the next IOTP Message in the IOTP transaction

  and send it to the required Trading Role. This is dependent on the
  IOTP Transaction, or

o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by sending

  a Cancel Block back to the Merchant containing a Status Component
  with a StatusType of Offer, a ProcessState of Failed and the
  CompletionCode (see section 7.16.4) set to either: ConsCancelled
  or Unspecified.

If the Merchant receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component for the Merchant.

If the Consumer receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the information contained in the IOTP Message should be reported to the Consumer but no further action taken.

Brand Independent Offer Document Exchange

In a Brand Independent Offer Document Exchange the TPO Block and the Offer Response Block are sent together by the Merchant to the Consumer, i.e. there is one IOTP Message that contains both a TPO Block, and an Offer Response Block.

The message flow is illustrated by the diagram below:

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Consumer
 |  Merchant

STEP | |

1.          Consumer decides to trade and sends to the Merchant
         information (e.g., using HTML) that enables the Merchant
         to create an offer,
 C --> M Offer information - outside scope of IOTP
2.          Merchant decides which payment brand protocols,
         currencies and amounts apply, places then in a Brand List
         Component inside a TPO Block, creates an Offer Response
         containing details about the IOTP Transaction including
         price, etc., optionally signs it  and sends to Consumer
 C <-- M TPO & OFFER RESPONSE. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Signature
         Block; TPO Block; Offer Response Block
3.          IOTP aware application started. Consumer selects the
         payment brand, payment protocol and currency/amount to
         use. Records selection in a Brand Selection Component,
         checks offer is OK, combines the Brand Selection
         Component with information from the TPO Block and Offer
         Response Block to create the next IOTP Message for the
         Transaction and sends it together with the Signature
         Block if present to the required Trading Role.
 CONTINUED ...
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
             Figure 20 Brand Independent Offer Exchange

Note that a Brand Independent Offer Document Exchange always occurs when only one payment brand, protocol and currency/amount is being offered to the Consumer by the Merchant. It is also likely to, but will not necessarily, occur when multiple brands are being offered, the Payment Handler is the same, and all brands use the same set of protocols.

Note that the TPO Block and the Offer Response Block can be sent in separate IOTP messages (see Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange) even if the Offer Response Block does not change. However this increases the number of messages in the transaction and is therefore likely to increase transaction response times.

IOTP aware applications supporting the Consumer Trading Role must check for the existence of an Offer Response Block in the first IOTP Message to determine whether the Offer Document Exchange is brand dependent or not.

MESSAGE PROCESSING GUIDELINES

On receiving a TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message (see below), the Consumer may either:

o generate and send the next IOTP Message in the IOTP transaction

  and send it to the required Trading Role. This is dependent on the
  IOTP Transaction, or

o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by sending

  a Cancel Block back to the Merchant containing a Status Component
  with a StatusType of Offer, a ProcessState of Failed and the
  CompletionCode (see section 7.16.1) set to either: ConsCancelled
  or Unspecified.

If the Merchant receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component for the Merchant.

TPO IOTP Message

The TPO IOTP Message is only used with a Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange. Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of just a Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 8.1) which is described below.

TPO (TRADING PROTOCOL OPTIONS) BLOCK

The Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 8.1) must contain the following Trading Components:

o one Protocol Options Component which defines the options which

  apply to the whole IOTP Transaction. See Section 7.1.

o one Brand List Component (see section 7.7) for each Payment in the

  IOTP Transaction that contain one or more payment brands and
  protocols which may be selected for use in each payment

o Organisation Components (see section 7.6) with the following

  roles:
  -  Merchant who is making the offer
  -  Consumer who is carrying out the transaction
  -  the PaymentHandler(s) for the payment. The "ID" of the Payment
     Handler Organisation Component is contained within the PhOrgRef
     attribute of the Payment Component

If the IOTP Transaction includes a Delivery then the TPO Block must also contain:

o Organisation Components with the following roles:

  -  DeliveryHandler who will be delivering the goods or services
  -  DelivTo i.e. the person or Organisation which is to take
     delivery

AUTHENTICATION STATUS AND SIGNATURE BLOCKS

If the Offer Document Exchange was preceded by an Authentication Document Exchange, then the TPO IOTP Message may also contain:

o an Authentication Status Block (see section 8.6), and

o an optional Signature Block (Authentication Status) Signature

  Block

See section 9.1.1.4 Authentication Status IOTP Message for more details.

TPO Selection IOTP Message

The TPO Selection IOTP Message is only used with a Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange. Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of just a TPO Selection Block (see section 8.1) which is described below.

TPO SELECTION BLOCK

The TPO Selection Block (see section 8.2) contains:

o one Brand Selection Component (see section 7.8) for use in a

  later Payment Exchange. It contains the results of the consumer
  selecting a Payment Brand, Payment Protocol and currency/amount
  from the list provided in the Brand List Component.
Offer Response IOTP Message

The Offer Response IOTP Message is only used with a Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange. Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of:

o an Offer Response Block (see section 8.1) and

o an optional Signature Block (see section 8.16).

OFFER RESPONSE BLOCK

The Offer Response Block (see section 8.3) contains the following components:

o one Status Component (see section 7.16) which indicates the status

  of the Offer Response. The ProcessState attribute should be set to
  CompletedOk

o one Order Component (see section 7.5) which contains details about

  the goods and services which are being purchased or the financial
  transaction which is taking place

o one or more Payment Component(s) (see section 7.9) for each

  payment which is to be made

o zero or one Delivery Components (see section 7.13) containing

  details of the delivery to be made if the IOTP Transaction
  includes a delivery

o zero or more Trading Role Data Components (see section 7.17) if

  required by the Merchant.

SIGNATURE BLOCK (OFFER RESPONSE)

If the Authentication Status Block is being digitally signed then a Signature Block must be included that contains a Signature Component (see section 7.19) with Digest Elements for the following XML elements:

If the Offer Response is being digitally signed then a Signature Block must be included that contains a Signature Component (see section 7.19) with Digest Elements for the following XML elements:

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP

  Message that contains information that describes the IOTP Message
  and IOTP Transaction

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) which globally

  uniquely identifies the IOTP Transaction

o the following components of the TPO Block :

  -  the Protocol Options Component, and
  -  the Brand List Component
  -  all the Organisation Components present

o the following components of the Offer Response Block:

  -  the Order Component
  -  all the Payment Components present
  -  the Delivery Component if present
  -  any Trading Role Data Components present
TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message

The TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message is only used with a Brand Independent Offer Document Exchange. Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of:

o a Trading Protocol Options Block (see section 8.1)

o an Offer Response Block (see section 8.1) and

o an optional Signature Block (see section 8.16).

TPO (TRADING PROTOCOL OPTIONS) BLOCK

This is the same as the Trading Protocol Options Block described in TPO IOTP Message (see section 9.1.2.3).

OFFER RESPONSE BLOCK

This the same as the Offer Response Block in the Offer Response IOTP Message (see section 9.1.2.5).

AUTHENTICATION STATUS

If the Offer Document Exchange was preceded by an Authentication Document Exchange, then the TPO and Offer Response IOTP Message may also contain an Authentication Status Block (see section 8.6).

SIGNATURE BLOCK

This is the same as the Signature Block in the Offer Response IOTP Message (see section 9.1.2.5) with the addition that:

o if the Offer Document Exchange is Brand Dependent then the

  Signature Component in the Signature Block additionally contains a
  Digest Element for the Brand Selection Component contained in the
  TPO Selection Block

o if the Offer Document Exchange was preceded by an Authentication

  Document Exchange then the Signature Component in the Signature
  Block additionally contains a Digest Element for the
  Authentication Status Block.

Payment Document Exchange

The Payment Document Exchange is a direct implementation of the last part of a Payment Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.2) after the Brand has been selected by the Consumer. A Payment Exchange consists of:

o the Consumer requesting that a payment starts by generating

  Payment Request IOTP Message using information from previous IOTP
  Messages in the Transaction and then sending it to the Payment
  Handler

o the Payment Handler and the Consumer then swapping Payment

  Exchange IOTP Messages encapsulating payment protocol messages
  until the payment is complete, and finally

o the Payment Handler sending a Payment Response IOTP Message to the

  Consumer containing a receipt for the payment.

The IOTP Messages which are involved are illustrated by the diagram below.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

Consumer

 |  Payment
 |  Handler

STEP | |

1.          Consumer generates Pay Request Block encapsulating a
         payment protocol message if required and sends to Payment
         Handler with the Signature Block if present
 C --> P PAYMENT REQUEST. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Signature
         Block (optional); Pay Request Block
2.          Payment Handler processes Pay Request Block, checks
         optional signature and starts exchanging payment protocol
         messages encapsulated in a Pay Exchange Block, with the
         Consumer
 C <-> P PAYMENT EXCHANGE. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Pay Exchange
         Block
3.          Consumer and Payment Handler keep on exchanging Payment
         Exchange blocks until eventually payment protocol
         messages finish so Payment Handler creates a Pay Receipt
         Component inside a Pay Response Block, and an optional
         Signature Component inside a Signature Block, sends them
         to the Consumer and stops.
 C <-- P PAYMENT RESPONSE. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Signature
         Block (optional); Pay Response Block
4.          Consumer checks Payment Response is OK. Optionally keeps
         information on IOTP Transaction for record keeping
         purposes and either stops or creates the next IOTP
         message for the Transaction and sends it together with
         the Signature Block, if present, to the required Trading
         Role
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                 Figure 21 Payment Document Exchange
Message Processing Guidelines

On receiving a Payment Request IOTP Message, the Payment Handler should check that they are authorised to carry out the Payment (see section 6 Digital Signatures). They may then either:

o generate and send a Payment Exchange IOTP Message back to the

  Consumer, if more payment protocol messages need to be exchanged,
  or

o generate and send a Payment Response IOTP Message if the exchange

  of payment protocol messages is complete, or

o indicate failure to continue with the Payment by sending a Cancel

  Block back to the Consumer containing a Status Component with a
  StatusType of Payment, a ProcessState of Failed and the
  CompletionCode (see section 7.16.4) set to either: BrandNotSupp,
  CurrNotSupp, PaymtCancelled, AuthError, InsuffFunds,
  InstBrandInvalid, InstNotValid, BadInstrument or Unspecified.

On receiving a Payment Exchange IOTP Message, the Consumer may either:

o generate and send a Payment Exchange Message back to the Payment

  Handler or

o indicate failure to continue with the Payment by sending a Cancel

  Block back to the Payment Handler containing a Status Component
  with a StatusType of Payment, a ProcessState of Failed and the
  CompletionCode (see section 7.16.2) set to either: ConsCancelled
  or Unspecified.

On receiving a Payment Exchange IOTP Message, the Payment Handler may either:

o generate and send a Payment Exchange IOTP Message back to the

  Consumer, if more payment protocol messages need to be exchanged,
  or

o generate and send a Payment Response IOTP Message if the exchange

  of payment protocol messages is complete, or

o indicate failure to continue with the Payment by sending a Cancel

  Block back to the Consumer containing a Status Component with a
  StatusType of Payment, a ProcessState of Failed and the
  CompletionCode (see section 7.16.2) set to either: PaymtCancelled
  or Unspecified.

On receiving a Payment Response IOTP Message, the Consumer may

  either:

o generate and send the next IOTP Message in the IOTP transaction

  and send it to the required Trading Role. This is dependent on the
  IOTP Transaction,

o stop, since the IOTP Transaction has ended, or

o indicate failure to continue with the IOTP Transaction by sending

  a Cancel Block back to the Merchant containing a Status Component
  with a StatusType of Payment, a ProcessState of Failed and the
  CompletionCode (see section 7.16.1) set to either: ConsCancelled
  or Unspecified.

If the Consumer receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the information contained in the IOTP Message should be reported to the Consumer but no further action taken.

If the Payment Handler receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component for the Payment Handler from which any further action may take place.

If the Merchant receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the Consumer should have completed the payment but not continuing with the transaction for some reason. In this case the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component for the Merchant from which any further action may take place.

Payment Request IOTP Message

Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of:

o a Payment Request Block, and

o an optional Signature Block

PAYMENT REQUEST BLOCK

The Payment Request Block (see section 8.7) contains:

o the following components copied from the Offer Response Block from

  the preceding Offer Document Exchange:
  -  the Status Component
  -  the Payment Component for the payment which is being carried
     out

o the following components from the TPO Block:

  -  the Organisation Components with the roles of Merchant and for
     the PaymentHandler that is being sent the Payment Request Block
  -  the Brand List Component for the payment, i.e. the Brand List
     referred to by the BrandListRef attribute on the Payment
     Component

o one Brand Selection Component for the Brand List, i.e. the Brand

  Selection Component where BrandListRef attribute points to the
  Brand List. This component can be either:
  -  copied from the TPO Selection Block if the payment was preceded
     by a Brand Dependent Offer Document Exchange (see section
     9.1.2.1), or
  -  created by the Consumer, containing the payment brand, payment
     protocol and currency/amount selected from the Brand List, if
     the payment was preceded by a Brand Independent Offer Document
     Exchange (see section 9.1.2.2)

o an optional Payment Scheme Component (see section 7.10) if

  required by the payment method used (see the Payment Method
  supplement to determine if this is needed).

o zero or more Trading Role Data Components (see section 7.17).

Note that:

o if there is more than one Payment Components in an Offer Response

  Block, then the second payment is the one within the Offer
  Response Block that contains a StartAfter attribute (see section
  7.9) that identifies the Payment Component for the first payment

o the Payment Handler to include is identified by the Brand

  Selection Component (see section 7.8) for the payment. Also see
  section 6.3.1 Check Request Block sent Correct Organisation for an
  explanation on how Payment Handlers are identified

o the Brand List Component to include is the one identified by the

  BrandListRef attribute of the Payment Component for the identified
  payment

o the Brand Selection Component to include from the Offer Response

  Block is the one that contains an BrandListRef attribute (see
  section 3.5) which identifies the Brand List Component for the
  second payment.

SIGNATURE BLOCK (PAYMENT REQUEST)

If the either the preceding Offer Document Exchange included an Offer Response Signature (see section 9.1.2.5 Offer Response IOTP Message), or a preceding Payment Exchange included a Payment Response Signature

(see section 9.1.3.4 Payment Response IOTP Message) then they should both be copied to the Signature Block in the Payment Request IOTP Message.

Payment Exchange IOTP Message

Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of just a Payment Exchange Block.

PAYMENT EXCHANGE BLOCK

The Payment Exchange Block (see section 8.8) contains:

o one Payment Scheme Component (see section 7.10) which contains

  payment method specific data. See the Payment Method supplement
  for the payment method being used to determine what this should
  contain.
Payment Response IOTP Message

Apart from a Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3), this message consists of:

o a Payment Response Block, and

o an optional Signature Block

PAYMENT RESPONSE BLOCK

The Payment Response Block (see section 8.9) contains:

o one Payment Receipt Component (see section 7.11) which contains

  scheme specific data which can be used to verify the payment
  occurred

o one Payment Scheme Component (see section 7.10) if required which

  contains payment method specific data. See the Payment Method
  supplement for the payment method being used to determine what
  this should contain

o an optional Payment Note Component (see section 7.12)

o zero or more Trading Role Data Components (see section 7.17).

SIGNATURE BLOCK (PAYMENT RESPONSE)

If a signed Payment Receipt is being provided, indicated by the SignedPayReceipt attribute of the Payment Component being set to True, then the Signature Block should contain a Signature Component which contains Digest Elements for the following:

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) for the IOTP

  Message which contains the first usage of the Payment Response
  Block,

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) within the

  Transaction Reference Block that globally uniquely identifies the
  IOTP Transaction,

o the Payment Receipt Component from the Payment Response Block,

o the Payment Note Component from the Payment Response Block,

o the other Components referenced by the PayReceiptNameRefs

  attribute (if present) of the Payment Receipt Component,

o the Status Component from the Payment Response Block,

o any Trading Role Data Components in the Payment Response Block,

  and

o all the Signature Components contained in the Payment Request

  Block if present.

Delivery Document Exchange

The Delivery Document Exchange is a direct implementation of a Delivery Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.3). It consists of:

o the Consumer requesting a Delivery by generating Delivery Request

  IOTP Message using information from previous IOTP Messages in the
  Transaction and then sending it to the Delivery Handler

o the Delivery Handler sending a Delivery Response IOTP Message to

  the Consumer containing details about the Handler's response to
  the request together with an optional signature.

The message flow is illustrated by the diagram below.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Consumer
 |  Delivery
 |  Handler

STEP | |

1.          Consumer generates Delivery Request Block and sends it to
         the Delivery Handler with the Signature Block if present
 C --> D DELIVERY REQUEST. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Signature
         Block; Delivery Request Block
2.          Delivery Handler checks the Status and Order Components
         in the Delivery Request and the optional Signatures,
         creates a Delivery Response Block, sends to the Consumer
         and stops.
 C <-- D DELIVERY RESPONSE. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Signature
         Block; Delivery Response Block

Consumer checks Delivery Response Block and optional

         Signature Block are OK. Optionally keeps information on
         IOTP Transaction for record keeping purposes and stops.
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                Figure 22 Delivery Document Exchange
Message Processing Guidelines

On receiving a Delivery Request IOTP Message, the Delivery Handler should check that they are authorised to carry out the Delivery (see section 6 Digital Signatures). They may then either:

o generate and send a Delivery Response IOTP Message to the

  Consumer, or

o indicate failure to continue with the Delivery by sending a Cancel

  Block back to the Consumer containing a Status Component with a
  StatusType of Delivery, a ProcessState of Failed and the
  CompletionCode (see section 7.16.4) set to either: DelivCanceled,
  or Unspecified.

On receiving a Delivery Response IOTP Message, the Consumer should just stop since the IOTP Transaction is complete.

If the Consumer receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the information contained in the IOTP Message should be reported to the Consumer but no further action taken.

Delivery Request IOTP Message

The Delivery Request IOTP Message consists of:

o a Delivery Request Block, and

o an optional Signature Block

DELIVERY REQUEST BLOCK

The Delivery Request Block (see section 8.10) contains:

o the following components copied from the Offer Response Block:

  -  the Status Component (see section 7.16)
  -  the Order Component (see section 7.5)
  -  the Organisation Component (see section 7.6) with the roles of:
     Merchant, DeliveryHandler and DeliverTo
  -  the Delivery Component (see section 7.13)

o the following Component from the Payment Response Block:

  -  the Status Component (see section 7.16).

o zero or more Trading Role Data Components (see section 7.17).

SIGNATURE BLOCK (DELIVERY REQUEST)

If the preceding Offer Document Exchange included an Offer Response Signature or the Payment Document Exchange included a Payment Response Signature, then they should both be copied to the Signature Block.

Delivery Response IOTP Message

The Delivery Response IOTP Message contains a Delivery Response Block and an optional Signature Block.

DELIVERY RESPONSE BLOCK

The Delivery Response Block contains:

o one Delivery Note Component (see section 7.15) which contains

  delivery instructions about the delivery of goods or services
  in3 SIGNATURE BLOCK (DELIVERY RESPONSE)
  The Signature Block should contain one Signature Component that
  contains Digest elements that refer to

o the Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) of the IOTP

  message that contains the Delivery  Response Signature

o the Transaction Reference Block (see section 3.3) of the IOTP

  Message that contains the Delivery  Response Signature

o the Consumer Delivery Data component contained in the Delivery

  Request Block (if any)

o the Signature Components contained in the Delivery Request Block

  (if any)

o the Status Component

o the Delivery Note Component

Payment and Delivery Document Exchange

The Payment and Delivery Document Exchange is a combination of the last part of the Payment Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.2) and a Delivery Trading Exchange (see section 2.2.3). It consists of:

o the Consumer requesting that a payment starts by generating

  Payment Request IOTP Message using information from previous IOTP
  Messages in the Transaction and then sending it to the Payment
  Handler

o the Payment Handler and the Consumer then swapping Payment

  Exchange IOTP Messages encapsulating payment protocol messages
  until the payment is complete, and finally

o the Payment Handler sending to the Consumer in one IOTP Message:

  -  a Payment Response Block containing a receipt for the payment,
     and
  -  a Delivery Response Block containing details of the goods or
     services to be delivered

The IOTP Messages which are involved are illustrated by the diagram below.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
Consumer
 |  Payment
 |  Handler

STEP | |

1.          Consumer generates Pay Request Block encapsulating a
         payment protocol message if required and sends to Payment
         Handler with the Signature Block if present
 C --> P PAYMENT REQUEST. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Signature
         Block; Pay Request Block
2.          Payment Handler processes Pay Request Block, checks
         optional signature and starts exchanging payment protocol
         messages encapsulated in a Pay Exchange Block, with the
         Consumer
 C <-> P PAYMENT EXCHANGE. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Pay Exchange
         Block
3.          Consumer and Payment Handler keep on exchanging Payment
         Exchange blocks until eventually payment protocol
         messages finish so Payment Handler creates a Pay Receipt
         Component inside a Pay Response Block, and an optional
         Signature Component inside a Signature Block, then uses
         information from the Offer Response Bock to create a
         Delivery Response Block and sends both to the Consumer
         and stops.
 C <-- P PAYMENT RESPONSE & DELIVERY RESPONSE. IotpMsg: Trans Ref
         Block; Signature Block; Pay Response Block; Delivery
         Response Block
4.          Consumer checks Payment Response and Delivery Response
         Blocks are OK. Optionally keeps information on IOTP
         Transaction for record keeping purposes and either stops
         or creates the next IOTP message for the Transaction and
         sends it together with the Signature Block, if present,
         to the required Trading Role
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
          Figure 23 Payment and Delivery Document Exchange

The Delivery Response Block and the Payment Response Block may be combined into the same IOTP Message only if the Payment Handler has the information available so that she can send the Delivery Response Block. This is likely to, but will not necessarily, occur when the Merchant, the Payment Handler and the Delivery Handler Roles are combined.

The DelivAndPayResp attribute of the Delivery Component (see section 7.13) contained within the Offer Response Block (see section 8.3) is set to True if the Delivery Response Block and the Payment Response Block are combined into the same IOTP Message and is set to False if the Delivery Response Block and the Payment Response Block are sent in separate IOTP Messages.

Message Processing Guidelines

On receiving a Payment Request IOTP Message or a Payment Exchange IOTP Message, the Payment Handler should carry out the same actions as for a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3.1).

On receiving a Payment Exchange IOTP Message, the Consumer should also carry out the same actions as for a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3.1).

On receiving a Payment Response and Delivery Response IOTP Message then the IOTP Transaction is complete and should take no further action.

If the Consumer receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the information contained in the IOTP Message should be reported to the Consumer but no further action taken.

If the Payment Handler receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component for the Payment Handler from which any further action may take place.

If the Merchant receives an IOTP Message containing a Cancel block, then the Consumer should have completed the payment but not continuing with the transaction for some reason. In this case the Consumer is likely to go to the CancelNetLocn specified on the Trading Role Element in the Organisation Component for the Merchant from which any further action may take place.

Payment Request IOTP Message

The content of this message is the same as for a Payment Request IOTP Message in a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3.2).

Payment Exchange IOTP Message

The content of this message is the same as for a Payment Exchange IOTP Message in a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3.3).

Payment Response and Delivery Response IOTP Message

The content of this message consists of:

o a Payment Response Block,

o an optional Signature Block (Payment Response), and

o a Delivery Response Block.

PAYMENT RESPONSE BLOCK

The content of this block is the same as the Payment Response Block in the Payment Response IOTP Message associated with a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3.4).

SIGNATURE BLOCK (PAYMENT RESPONSE)

The content of this block is the same as the Signature Block (Payment Response) in the Payment Response IOTP Message associated with a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3.4).

DELIVERY RESPONSE BLOCK

The content of this block is the same as the Delivery Response Block in the Delivery Response IOTP Message associated with a Delivery Document Exchange (see section 9.1.4.3).

Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction

A Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction may occur at any time between any of the Trading Roles involved in IOTP Transactions. This means it could occur:

o before another IOTP Transaction

o at the same time as another IOTP Transaction

o independently of any other IOTP Transaction.

The Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction consists of just an Authentication Document Exchange (see section 9.1.1) as illustrated by the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

START -------------------------------------------------------

                                                            v
                                                   ----------------
                                                  | AUTHENTICATION |
                                                   ----------------
                                                             |
                                                             |
                                                             |
                                                             |
              -------------------     -----------------      |
             | BRAND INDEPENDENT |   | BRAND DEPENDENT |     |
             |       OFFER       |   |      OFFER      |     |
              -------------------     -----------------      |
                                                             |
                                                             |
                                                             |
                                                             |
                                                             |
                  ---------           --------------         |
                 | PAYMENT |         | PAYMENT WITH |        |
                 | (first) |         |   DELIVERY   |        |
                  ---------           --------------         |
                                                             |
                                                             |
                                                             |
     ----------        ---------                             |
    | DELIVERY |      | PAYMENT |                            |
    |          |      | {second)|                            |
     ----------        ---------                             |
                                                             v
                                                           STOP
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
           Figure 24 Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction

Example uses of the Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction include:

o when the Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction takes place as

  an early part of a session where strong continuity exists. For
  example, a Financial Institution could:
  -  set up a secure channel (e.g., using [SSL/TLS]) with a customer
  -  authenticate the customer using the Baseline Authentication
     IOTP Transaction, and then
  -  provide the customer with access to account information and
     other services with the confidence that they are communicating
     with a bona fide customer.

o as a means of providing a Merchant role with Organisation

  Components that contain information about Consumer and DelivTo
  Trading Roles

o so that a Consumer may authenticate a Payment Handler before

  starting a payment.

Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction

The Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction supports the deposit of electronic cash with a Financial Institution.

Note: The Financial Institution has, in IOTP terminology, a role of merchant in that a service (i.e. a deposit of electronic cash) is being offered in return for a fee, for example bank charges of some kind. The term "Financial Institution" is used in the diagrams and in the text for clarity.

The Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction consists of the following Document Exchanges:

o an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section 9.1.1)

o an Offer Document Exchange (see section 9.1.2), and

o a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3).

The way in which these Document Exchanges may be combined together is illustrated by the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

START -----------------------------------------------------

  |                                                       v
  |                                                ----------------
  |                                               | AUTHENTICATION |
  |                                                ----------------
   --------------------------------------               |
                   |                     |              |
                   |      -------------- | -------------
                   v      v              v      v
              -------------------     -----------------
             | BRAND INDEPENDENT |   | BRAND DEPENDENT |
             |       OFFER       |   |      OFFER      |
              -------------------     -----------------
                    |                        |
                    |                        |
                    |                        |
                    |     -------------------
                    v    v
                  ---------           --------------
                 | PAYMENT |         | PAYMENT WITH |
                 | (first) |         |   DELIVERY   |
                  ---------           --------------
                      |
                       ----------------
                                       |
     ----------        ---------       |
    | DELIVERY |      | PAYMENT |      |
    |          |      | {second)|      |
     ----------        ---------       |
                                       |
                                        -----------------> STOP
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
               Figure 25 Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction

See section 9.1.12 "Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges" to determine which combination of document exchanges apply to a particular instance of an IOTP Transaction

Note that:

o a Merchant (Financial Institution) may be able to accept a deposit

  in several different types of electronic cash although, since the
  Consumer role that is depositing the electronic cash usually knows
  what type of cash they want to deposit, it is usually constrained
  in practice to only one type. However, there may be several
  different protocols which may be used for the same "brand" of
  electronic cash. In this case a Brand Dependent Offer may be
  appropriate to negotiate the protocol to be used.

o the Merchant (Financial Institution) may use the results of the

  authentication to identify not only the consumer but also the
  account to which the payment is to be deposited. If no single
  account can be identified, then it must be obtained by other
  means. For example:
  -  the consumer could specify the account number prior to the
     Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction starting, or
  -  the consumer could have been identified earlier, for example
     using a Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction, and an
     account selected from a list provided by the Financial
     Institution.

o The Baseline Deposit IOTP Transaction without an Authentication

  Document Exchange might be used:
  -  if a previous IOTP transaction, for example a Baseline
     Withdrawal or a Baseline Authentication, authenticated the
     consumer, and a secure channel has been maintained, therefore
     the authenticity of the consumer is known
  -  if authentication is achieved as part of a proprietary payment
     protocol and is therefore included in the Payment Document
     Exchange
  -  if authentication of the consumer has been achieved by some
     other means outside of the scope of IOTP, for example, by using
     a pass phrase, or a proprietary banking software solution.

Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction

The Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction supports the purchase of goods or services using any payment method. It consists of the following Document Exchanges:

o an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section 9.1.1)

o an Offer Document Exchange (see section 9.1.2)

o either:

  -  a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3) followed by
  -  a Delivery Document Exchange (see section 9.1.4)

o a Payment Document Exchange only, or

o a combined Payment and Delivery Document Exchange (see section

  9.1.5).

The ways in which these Document Exchanges are combined is illustrated by the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

START -----------------------------------------------------

  |                                                       v
  |                                                ----------------
  |                                               | AUTHENTICATION |
  |                                                ----------------
   --------------------------------------               |    |
                   |                     |              |    |
                   |      -------------- | -------------     |
                   v      v              v      v            |
              -------------------     -----------------      |
             | BRAND INDEPENDENT |   | BRAND DEPENDENT |     |
             |       OFFER       |   |      OFFER      |     |
              -------------------     -----------------      |
                    |    |                   |   |           |
                    |     ---------------    |   |           |
                    |                    |   |   |           |
                    |     -------------- | --    |           |
                    v    v               v       v           |
                  ---------           --------------         |
                 | PAYMENT |         | PAYMENT WITH |        |
                 | (first) |         |   DELIVERY   |        |
                  ---------           --------------         |
                      |                      |               |
          -----------------------------      |               |
          v                            |     |               |
     ----------        ---------       |     |               |
    | DELIVERY |      | PAYMENT |      |     |               |
    |          |      | {second)|      |     |               |
     ----------        ---------       |     |               |
          |                            |     |               v
           ----------------------------------------------> STOP
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
              Figure 26 Baseline Purchase IOTP Transaction

See section 9.1.12 "Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges" to determine which combination of document exchanges apply to a particular instance of an IOTP Transaction.

Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction

In business terms the refund process typically consists of:

o a request for a refund being made by the Consumer to the Merchant,

  typically supported by evidence to demonstrate:
  -  the original trade took place, for example by providing a
     receipt for the original transaction
  -  using some type of authentication, that the consumer requesting
     the refund is the consumer, or a representative of the
     consumer, who carried out the original trade
  -  the reason why the merchant should make the refund

o the merchant agreeing (or not) to the refund. This may involve

  some negotiation between the Consumer and the Merchant, and, if
  the merchant agrees,

o a refund payment by the Merchant to the Consumer.

The Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction supports a subset of the above, specifically it supports:

o stand alone authentication of the Consumer using a separate

  Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction (see section 9.1.6)

o a refund payment by the Merchant to the Consumer using the

  following two Trading Exchanges:
  -  an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section
     9.1.1)
  -  an Offer Document Exchange (see section 9.1.2), and
  -  a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3).

The ways in which these Document Exchanges are combined is illustrated by the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

START -----------------------------------------------------

  |                                                       v
  |                                                ----------------
  |                                               | AUTHENTICATION |
  |                                                ----------------
   --------------------------------------               |
                   |                     |              |
                   |      -------------- | -------------
                   v      v              v      v
              -------------------     -----------------
             | BRAND INDEPENDENT |   | BRAND DEPENDENT |
             |       OFFER       |   |      OFFER      |
              -------------------     -----------------
                    |                        |
                    |                        |
                    |                        |
                    |     -------------------
                    v    v
                  ---------           --------------
                 | PAYMENT |         | PAYMENT WITH |
                 | (first) |         |   DELIVERY   |
                  ---------           --------------
                      |
                       ----------------
                                       |
     ----------        ---------       |
    | DELIVERY |      | PAYMENT |      |
    |          |      | {second)|      |
     ----------        ---------       |
                                       |
                                        -----------------> STOP
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
               Figure 27 Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction

A Baseline Refund IOTP Transaction without an Authentication Document Exchange might be used:

o when authentication of the consumer has been achieved by some

  other means, for example, the consumer has entered some previously
  supplied code in order to identify herself and the refund to which
  the code applies. The code could be supplied, for example on a web
  page or by e-mail.

o when a previous IOTP transaction, for example a Baseline

  Authentication, authenticated the consumer, and a secure channel
  has been maintained, therefore the authenticity of the consumer is
  known and therefore the previously agreed refund can be
  identified.

o when the authentication of the consumer is carried out by the

  Payment Handler using a payment scheme authentication algorithm.

9.1.10 Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction

The Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction supports the withdrawal of electronic cash from a Financial Institution.

Note: The Financial Institution has, in IOTP terminology, a role of merchant in that a service (i.e. a withdrawal of electronic cash) is being offered in return for a fee, for example bank charges of some kind. The term "Financial Institution" is used in the diagrams and in the text for clarity.

The Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction consists of the following Document Exchanges:

o an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section 9.1.1)

o an Offer Document Exchange (see section 9.1.2), and

o a Payment Document Exchange (see section 9.1.3).

The way in which these Document Exchanges may be combined together is illustrated by the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

START -----------------------------------------------------

  |                                                       v
  |                                                ----------------
  |                                               | AUTHENTICATION |
  |                                                ----------------
   --------------------------------------               |
                   |                     |              |
                   |      -------------- | -------------
                   v      v              v      v
              -------------------     -----------------
             | BRAND INDEPENDENT |   | BRAND DEPENDENT |
             |       OFFER       |   |      OFFER      |
              -------------------     -----------------
                    |                        |
                    |                        |
                    |                        |
                    |     -------------------
                    v    v
                  ---------           --------------
                 | PAYMENT |         | PAYMENT WITH |
                 | (first) |         |   DELIVERY   |
                  ---------           --------------
                      |
                       ----------------
                                       |
     ----------        ---------       |
    | DELIVERY |      | PAYMENT |      |
    |          |      | {second)|      |
     ----------        ---------       |
                                       |
                                        -----------------> STOP
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
             Figure 28 Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction

Note that:

o a Merchant (Financial Institution) may be able to offer withdrawal

  of several different types of electronic cash. In practice usually
  only one form of electronic cash may be offered. However, there
  may be several different protocols which may be used for the same
  "brand" of electronic cash.

o the Merchant (Financial Institution) may use the results of the

  authentication to identify not only the consumer but also the
  account from which the withdrawal is to be made. If no single
  account can be identified, then it must be obtained by other
  means. For example:
  -  the consumer could specify the account number prior to the
     Baseline Withdrawal IOTP Transaction starting, or
  -  the consumer could have been identified earlier, for example
     using a Baseline Authentication IOTP Transaction, and an
     account selected from a list provided by the Financial
     Institution.

o a Baseline Withdrawal without an authentication might be used:

  -  if a previous IOTP transaction, for example a Baseline Deposit
     or a Baseline Authentication, authenticated the consumer, and a
     secure channel has been maintained, therefore the authenticity
     of the consumer is known
  -  if authentication is achieved as part of a proprietary payment
     protocol and is therefore included in the Payment Document
     Exchange
  -  if authentication of the consumer has been achieved by some
     other means, for example, by using a pass phrase, or a
     proprietary banking software solution.

9.1.11 Baseline Value Exchange IOTP Transaction

The Baseline Value Exchange Transaction uses Payment Document Exchanges to support the exchange of value in one currency obtained using one payment method with value in the same or another currency using the same or another payment method. Examples of its use include:

o electronic cash advance on a credit card. For example the first

  payment could be a "dollar SET Payment" using a credit card with
  the second payment being a download of Visa Cash e-cash in
  dollars.

o foreign exchange using the same payment method. For example the

  payment could be an upload of Mondex value in British Pounds and
  the second a download of Mondex value in Euros

o foreign exchange using different payment methods. For example the

  first payment could be a SET payment in Canadian Dollars followed
  a download of GeldKarte in Deutchmarks.

The Baseline Value Exchange uses the following Document Exchanges:

o an optional Authentication Document Exchange (see section 9.1.1)

o an Offer Document Exchange (see section 9.1.2), which provides

  details of what values and currencies will be exchanged, and

o two Payment Document Exchanges (see section 9.1.3) which carry out

  the two payments involved.

The way in which these Document Exchanges may be combined together is illustrated by the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

START -----------------------------------------------------

  |                                                         v
  |                                                ----------------
  |                                               | AUTHENTICATION |
  |                                                ----------------
   --------------------------------------               |
                   |                     |              |
                   |      -------------- | -------------
                   v      v              v      v
              -------------------     -----------------
             | BRAND INDEPENDENT |   | BRAND DEPENDENT |
             |       OFFER       |   |      OFFER      |
              -------------------     -----------------
                    |                        |
                    |                        |
                    |                        |
                    |     -------------------
                    v    v
                  ---------           --------------
                 | PAYMENT |         | PAYMENT WITH |
                 | (first) |         |   DELIVERY   |
                  ---------           --------------
                      |
                       ----
                           v
     ----------        ---------
    | DELIVERY |      | PAYMENT |
    |          |      | {second)|
     ----------        ---------
                           |
                            -----------------------------> STOP
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
           Figure 29 Baseline Value Exchange IOTP Transaction

The Baseline Value Exchange IOTP Transaction occurs in two basic forms:

o Brand Dependent Value Exchange. Where the content of the offer,

  for example the rate at which one form of value is exchanged for
  another, is dependent on the payment brands and protocols selected
  by the consumer, and

o Brand Independent Value Exchange. Where the content of the offer

  is not dependent on the payment brands and protocols selected.

Note: In the above the role is a Merchant even though the Organisation carrying out the Value Exchange may be a Bank or some other Financial Institution. This is because the Bank is acting as a merchant in that they are making an offer which the Consumer can either accept or decline.

The TPO Block and Offer Response Block may only be combined into the same IOTP Message if the content of the Offer Response Block does not change as a result of selecting the payment brands and payment protocols to be used in the Value Exchange.

BASELINE VALUE EXCHANGE SIGNATURES

The use of signatures to ensure the integrity of a Baseline Value Exchange is illustrated by the diagram below.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

Signature generated IotpMsg (TPO) by Merchant ensures - Trans Ref Block integrity of the Offer --------> - - Signature Block

                             |   - TPO Block              MERCHANT
                             |   - Offer Response Block
                             |

Signature generated by | the Payment Handler of | IotpMsg (Pay Resp 1) the first payment binds | - Trans Ref Block PAYMENT Pay Receipt for the first -----> -> - Signature Block ----- HANDLER payment to the Offer - Pay Response Block 1 | 1

                                                        |

Signature generated by | the Payment Handler of IotpMsg (Pay Resp 2) | PAYMENT the second payment binds - Trans Ref Block | HANDLER the second payment to the -----> - Signature Block <------ 2 first payment and therefore - Pay Response Block 2 to the Offer

  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
          Figure 30 Baseline Value Exchange Signatures

9.1.12 Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges

The following diagram illustrates the data conditions in the various IOTP messages which can be used by a Consumer Trading Role to determine whether the combination of Document Exchanges are valid.

  • +*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

START

 |
 v

Auth Request Block in =TRUE

first IOTP Message ? ---------------------------------------
  | = FALSE                                                 |
  v                                                         v

Offer Response Block in ----------------

 first IOTP Message ?                             | AUTHENTICATION |
  |=TRUE         |=FALSE                           ----------------
  |              |                                        |
  |              |                                        v
  |                ----------------------       TPO & Offer Response
   -------------                         |   Blocks in last IOTP Msg
                |                        |     |=TRUE        |=FALSE
                |                        |     |             v
                |          ------------- | ----    TPO Block only if
                |         |              |         last IOTP Message
                |         |              |         of Authentication
                |         |              |          |=TRUE   |=FALSE
                v         v              v          v        |
              -------------------     -----------------      |
             | BRAND INDEPENDENT |   | BRAND DEPENDENT |     |
             |       OFFER       |   |      OFFER      |     |
              -------------------     -----------------      |
                      |                   |                  |
                      v                   v                  |
                   Offer Response Block contains             |
                         Delivery Component ?                |
                        |=FALSE        |=TRUE                |
                     ---               v                     |
                    |        Value of DelivAndPayResp        |
                    |    attribute of Delivery Component ?   |
                    |    |=FALSE         |=TRUE              |
                    |    |               |                   |
                    v    v               v                   |
                  ---------           --------------         |
                 | PAYMENT |         | PAYMENT WITH |        |
                 | (first) |         |   DELIVERY   |        |
                  ---------           --------------         |
                      |                      |               |
                      v                      |               |
        Offer and Response Block contains     -------------->|
              Delivery Component ?                           |
              |=TRUE           |=FALSE                       |
              |                v                             |
              |         Two Payment Components               |
              |      present in Offer Response Block?        |
              |           |=TRUE             |=FALSE         |
              v           v                  |               |
     ----------        ---------             |               |
    | DELIVERY |      | PAYMENT |            |               |
    |          |      | {second)|            |               |
     ----------        ---------             |               |
          |                |                 |               v
           ----------------------------------------------> STOP
  • -*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
           Figure 31 Valid Combinations of Document Exchanges

1) If first IOTP Message of an IOTP Transaction contains an

  Authentication Request then:
  a) IOTP Transaction includes an Authentication Document Exchange
     (see section 9.1.1). (Note 1)
  b) If the last IOTP Message of the Authentication Document
     Exchange includes a TPO Block and an Offer Response Block then:
     i) IOTP Transaction includes a Brand Independent Offer Document
        Exchange (see section 9.1.2.2). (Note 2)
  c) Otherwise, if the last IOTP Message of the Authentication
     Exchange includes a TPO Block but NO Offer Response Block,
     then:
     i) IOTP Transaction includes a Brand Dependent Offer Document
        Exchange (see section 9.1.2.1). (Note 2)
  d) Otherwise (Authentication Status IOTP Message of the
     Authentication Document Exchange contains neither a TPO Block
     but nor an Offer Response Block)
     i) IOTP Transaction consists of just an Authentication Document
        Exchange. (Note 3)

2) Otherwise (no Authentication Request in first IOTP Message):

  e) IOTP Transaction does not include an Authentication Document
     Exchange (Note 2)
  f) If first IOTP Message contains an Offer Response Block, then:
     i) the IOTP Transaction contains a Brand Independent Offer
        Document Exchange (Note 2)
  g) Otherwise (no Offer Response Block in first IOTP Message):
     i) the IOTP Transaction includes a Brand Dependent Offer
        Document Exchange (Note 2)

3) If an Offer Response Block exists in any IOTP message then:

  h) If the Offer Response Block contains a Delivery Component then:
     i) If the DelivAndPayResp attribute of the Delivery Component
        is set to True, then:
        (1) the IOTP Transaction consists of a Payment And Delivery
            Document Exchange (see section 9.1.5) (Note 4)
    ii) otherwise (the DelivAndPayResp attribute of the Delivery
        Component is set to False)
        (1) the IOTP Transaction consists of a Payment Document
            Exchange (see section 9.1.3) followed by a Delivery
            Document Exchange (see section 9.1.4) (Note 4)
  i) otherwise (the Offer Response Block does not contain a Delivery
     Component)
     i) if the Offer Response Block contains just one Payment
        Component, then:
        (1) the IOTP Transaction contains just one Payment Document
            Exchange (Note 5)
    ii) if the Offer Response Block contains two Payment Components,
        then:
        (1) the IOTP Transaction contains two Payment Document
            Exchanges.  The StartAfter attribute of the Payment
            Components is used to indicate which payment occurs
            first (Note 6)
   iii) if the Offer Response Block contains no or more than two
        Payment Components, then there is an error

4) Otherwise (no Offer Response Block) there is an error.

The following table indicates the types of IOTP Transactions which can validly have the conditions indicated above.

Note IOTP Transaction Validity

1. Any Payment and Authentication IOTP Transaction

2. Any Payment and Authentication IOTP Transaction except Baseline

  Authentication

3. Either Baseline Authentication, or a Baseline Purchase, Refund,

  Deposit, Withdrawal or Value Exchange with a failed Authentication

4. Baseline Purchase only

5. Baseline Purchase, Refund, Deposit or Withdrawal

6. Baseline Value Exchange only

9.1.13 Combining Authentication Transactions with other Transactions

In the previous sections an Authentication Document Exchange is shown preceding an Offer Document Exchange as part of a single IOTP Transaction with the same IOTP Transaction Id.

It is also possible to run a separate Authentication Transaction at any point, even in parallel with another IOTP Transaction. Typically this will be used:

o by a Consumer to authenticate a Merchant, Payment Handler or a

  Delivery Handler, or

o by a Payment Handler or Delivery Handler to authenticate a

  Consumer.

In outline the basic process consists of:

o the Trading Role that decides it wants to carry out an

  authentication of another role suspends the current IOTP
  transaction being carried out

o a stand-alone Authentication transaction is then carried out. This

  may, at implementer's option, be linked to the original IOTP
  Transaction using a Related To Component (see section 3.3.3) in
  the Transaction Reference Block.

o if the Authentication transaction is successful, then the original

  IOTP Transaction is restarted

o if the Authentication fails then the original IOTP Transaction is

  cancelled.

For example, a Consumer could:

o authenticate the Payment Handler for a Payment between receiving

  an Offer Response from a Merchant and before sending the Payment
  Request to that Payment Handler

o authenticate a Delivery Handler for a Delivery between receiving

  the Payment Response from a Payment Handler and before sending the
  Delivery Request

A Payment Handler could authenticate a Consumer after receiving the Payment Request and before sending the next Payment related message.

A Delivery Handler could authenticate a Consumer after receiving the Delivery Request and before sending the Delivery Response.

Note: Some Payment Methods may carry out an authentication within the Payment Exchange. In this case the information required to carry out the authentication will be included in Payment Scheme Components.

In this instance IOTP aware application will not be aware that an authentication has occurred since the Payment Scheme Components that contain authentication request information will be indistinguishable from other Payment Scheme Components.

Infrastructure Transactions

Infrastructure Transactions are designed to support inquiries about whether or not a transaction has succeeded or a Trading Role's servers are operating correctly. There are two types of transaction:

o a Transaction Status Inquiry Transaction which provides

  information on the status of an existing or complete IOTP
  transaction, and

o Ping Transaction that enables one IOTP aware application to

  determine if the IOTP aware application at another Trading Role is
  operating and verify whether or not signatures can be handled.

Each of these is described below

Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry IOTP Transaction

The Baseline IOTP Transaction Status Inquiry provides information on the status of an existing or complete IOTP transaction.

The Trading Blocks used by the Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry Transaction are:

o an Inquiry Request Trading Block (see section 8.12),

o an Inquiry Response Trading Block (see section 8.13)

o an optional Signature Block (see section 8.16).

The Inquiry IOTP Transaction can be used for a variety of reasons. For example:

o to help in resuming a suspended transaction to determine the

  current state of processing of one of the other roles,

o for a merchant to determine if a payment, delivery, etc., was

  completed.  For example, a Consumer might claim that payment was
  made but no signed IOTP payment receipt was available to prove it.
  If the Merchant makes an inquiry of the Payment Handler then the
  Merchant can determine whether or not payment was made.

Note: Inquiries on Baseline Ping IOTP Transactions (see section 9.2.2) are ignored.

MAKING INQUIRIES OF ANOTHER TRADING ROLE

One Trading Role may make an inquiry of any other Trading Role at any point in time.

IOTP aware software that supports the Consumer Trading Role may not:

o digitally sign a response if requested, since it may not have the

  capability, or

o respond to an Inquiry Request at all since it may not be on-line,

  or may consider that the request is not reasonable since, for
  example, the Request was not digitally signed.

As a guideline:

o the Consumer should send a Transaction Status Inquiry Block to a

  Trading Role only after the following events have occurred:
  - to the Merchant, after sending a TPO Selection Block,
  - to the Payment Handler, after sending a Payment Request Block,
  - to the Delivery Handler, after sending a Delivery Request Block,

o other Trading Roles should send a Transaction Status Inquiry Block

  to the Consumer only after receiving a message from the Consumer
  and before sending the final "Response" message to the Consumer

o there are no restrictions on non-Consumer Trading Roles sending

  Inquiries to other trading roles.

TRANSACTION STATUS INQUIRY TRANSPORT SESSION

For a Transaction Status Inquiry on an ongoing transaction a different transport session from the ongoing transaction is used. For a Transaction Status Inquiry on a past transaction, how the IOTP

module on the software at the Trading Role is started upon the receipt of Inquiry Request message is defined in each Mapping to Transport supplement for IOTP.

TRANSACTION STATUS INQUIRY ERROR HANDLING

Errors in a Transaction Status Inquiry can be categorised into one of the following three cases:

o Business errors (see section 4.2) in the original (inquired)

  messages

o Technical errors (see section 4.1) - both IOTP and payment scheme

  specific ones - in the original IOTP (inquired) messages

o Technical errors in the message containing the Inquiry Request

  Block itself

The following outlines what the software should do in each case

BUSINESS ERRORS IN THE ORIGINAL MESSAGES

Return an Inquiry Response Block containing the Status Component which was last sent to the Consumer Role.

TECHNICAL ERRORS IN THE ORIGINAL MESSAGES

Return an Inquiry Response Block containing a Status Component. The Status Component should contain a ProcessState attribute set to ProcessError. In this case send back an Error Block indicating where the error was found in the original message.

TECHNICAL ERRORS IN THE INQUIRY REQUEST BLOCK

Return an Error message. That is, send back an Error Block containing the Error Code (see section 7.21.2) which describes the nature of the error in the Inquiry Request message.

INQUIRY TRANSACTION MESSAGES

The following Figure outlines the Baseline IOTP Transaction Status Inquiry process.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*

1st Role

 |  2nd Role

STEP | |

1.          The first role decides to inquire on an IOTP Transaction
         by, for example, clicking on the inquiry button of an
         IOTP Aware Application. This will then generate an
         Inquiry Request Block and send it to the appropriate
         Trading Role.
 1 --> 2 INQUIRY REQUEST. IotpMsg: TransRef Block; Signature Block
         (optional); Inquiry Request Block
2.          The Trading Role checks the digital signature (if
         present). If the recipient wants to respond, then the
         Trading Role checks the transaction status of the
         transaction that is being inquired upon by using the
         IotpTransId in the Transaction ID Component of the
         Transaction Reference Block, then generates the
         appropriate Inquiry Response Block, sends the message
         back to the 1st Role and stops
 1 <-- 2 INQUIRY RESPONSE. IotpMsg: TransRef Block; Inquiry
         Response Block; Signature Block (Optional)

First role checks the Inquiry Response Block and optional

         signature, takes whatever action is appropriate or
         perhaps stops. This may include displaying status
         information to the end user.
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
            Figure 32 Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry

The remainder of this sub-section on the Baseline Transaction Status Inquiry IOTP Transaction defines the contents of each Trading Block. Note that the term "original transaction" is the transaction which a trading role wants to discover some information about.

TRANSACTION REFERENCE BLOCK

A Trading Role making an inquiry must use a Transaction Id Component (see section 3.3.1) where both the IotpTransId and TransTimeStamp attributes are the same as in the Transaction Id Component of the original transaction that is being inquired upon. The IotpTransId attribute in this component serves as the key in querying the

transaction logs maintained at the Trading Role's site. The value of the ID attribute of the Message Id Component should be different from those of any in the original transaction (see section 3.4.1).

If up-to-date status information is required then the MsgId Component, and in particular the ID attribute for the MsgId Component must be different from any other IOTP Message that has been sent by the Trading Role. This is required because of the way that Idempotency is handled by IOTP (see section 4.5.2.2 Checking/Handling Duplicate Messages).

INQUIRY REQUEST BLOCK

The Inquiry Request Block (see section 8.12) contains the following components:

o one Inquiry Type Component (see section 7.18). This identifies

  whether the inquiry is on an offer, payment, or delivery.

o zero or one Payment Scheme Components (see section 7.10). This is

  for encapsulating payment scheme specific inquiry messages for
  inquiries on a payment.

SIGNATURE BLOCK (INQUIRY REQUEST)

If a signature block is present on the message containing the Inquiry Request Block then it may be checked to determine if the Inquiry Request is authorised.

If present, the Inquiry Request Signature Block (see section 8.12) contains the following components:

o one Signature Component (see section 7.19)

o one or more Certificate Components, if required.

Inquiry Response Blocks should only be generated if the Transaction is authorised.

Note: Digital signatures on an Inquiry Request is only likely to occur if the recipient of the request expects the Inquiry Request to be signed. In this version of IOTP this will require some kind of pre-existing agreement. This means that:

o Consumers are unlikely to generate requests with signatures,

  although it is not an error if they do

o the other trading roles may agree that digital signatures are

  required. For example a Payment Handler may require that an
  Inquiry Request is digitally signed by the Merchant so that they
  can check that the request is valid.

On the other hand if the original transaction to which the Inquiry relates was carried out over a secure channel (e.g., [SSL]) then it is probably reasonable to presume that if the sender of the Inquiry knows the Transaction Id component of the original message (including for example the timestamp) then the inquiry is likely to be genuine.

INQUIRY RESPONSE BLOCK

The Inquiry Response Block (see section 8.13) contains the following components:

o one Status Component (see section 7.16). This component holds the

  status information on the inquired transaction,

o zero or one Payment Scheme Components. These contain encapsulated

  payment scheme specific inquiry messages for inquiries on payment.

SIGNATURE BLOCK (INQUIRY RESPONSE)

If a signature block is present on the message containing the Inquiry Response Block then it may be checked by the receiver of the block to determine if the Inquiry Response is valid.

If present, the Inquiry Response Signature Block (see section 8.13) contains the following components:

o one Signature Component (see section 7.19)

o one or more Certificate Components, if required.

Note: Digital signatures on an Inquiry Response is only likely to occur if the recipient of the response expects the Inquiry Request to be signed. In this version of IOTP this will require some kind of pre-existing agreement. This means that:

o Consumers are unlikely to generate responses with signatures,

  although it is not an error if they do

o the other trading roles may agree that digital signatures are

  required. For example a Merchant may require that an Inquiry
  Response is digitally signed by the Payment Handler so that they
  can check that the request response is valid.

Baseline Ping IOTP Transaction

The purpose of the Baseline IOTP Ping Transaction is to test basic connectivity between the Trading Roles that may take part in an IOTP Transaction.

It enables IOTP aware application software to:

o determine if the IOTP aware application at another Trading Role is

  operating, and

o verify whether or not the two trading roles signatures can be

  processed.

For example it can be used by a Merchant to determine if a Payment Handler or Delivery Handler is up and running prior to starting a Purchase transaction that uses those trading roles.

The Trading Blocks used by the Baseline Ping IOTP Transaction are:

o a Ping Request Block (see section 8.14)

o a Ping Response Block (see section 8.15), and

o a Signature Block (see section 8.16).

PING MESSAGES

The following figure outlines the message flows in the Baseline IOTP Ping Transaction.

*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*+*
1st Role
 |  2nd Role

STEP | |

1.          The IOTP Aware Application in the first Trading Role
         decides to check whether the counterparty IOTP
         application is up and running. It generates a Ping
         Request Block and optional Signature Block and sends them
         to the second trading role.
 1 --> 2 PING REQUEST. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Signature Block
         (Optional); Ping Request Block
2.          The second Trading Role which receives the Ping Request
         Block generates a Ping Response Block and sends it back
         to the sender of the original Ping Request with a
         signature block if required.
 1 <-- 2 PING Response. IotpMsg: Trans Ref Block; Signature Block
         (Optional); Ping Response Block
3.          The first Trading Role checks the Ping Response Block and
         takes appropriate action, if necessary
*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*-*
                  Figure 33 Baseline Ping Messages

The verification that signatures can be handled is indicated by the sender of the Ping Request Block including:

o Organisation Components that identify itself and the intended

  recipient of the Ping Request Block, and

o a Signature Block that signs data in the Ping Request.

In this way the receiver of the Ping Request:

o knows who is sending the Ping Request and can therefore verify the

  Signature on the Request, and

o knows who to generate a signature for on the Ping Response.

Note that a Ping Request:

o does not affect any on-going transaction

o does NOT initiate an IOTP transaction, unlike other IOTP

  transaction messages such as TPO or Transaction Status Inquiry.

All IOTP aware applications must return a Ping Response message to the sender of a Ping Request message when it is received.

A Baseline IOTP Ping request can also contain an optional Signature Block. IOTP aware applications can, for example, use the Signature Block to check the recipient of a Ping Request can successfully process and check signatures it has received.

For each Baseline Ping IOTP Transaction, each IOTP role shall establish a different transport session from other IOTP transactions.

Any IOTP Trading Role can send a Ping request to any other IOTP Trading Role at any time it wants. A Ping message has its own IotpTransId, which is different from other IOTP transactions.

The remainder of this sub-section on the Baseline Ping IOTP Transaction defines the contents of each Trading Block.

TRANSACTION REFERENCE BLOCK

The IotpTransId of a Ping transaction should be different from any other IOTP transaction.

PING REQUEST BLOCK

If the Ping Transaction is anonymous then no Organisation Components are included in the Ping Request Block (see section 8.7).

If the Ping Transaction is not anonymous then the Ping Request Block contains Organisation Components for:

o the sender of the Ping Request Block, and

o the verifier of the Signature Component

If Organisation Components are present, then it indicates that the sender of the Ping Request message has generated a Signature Block. The signature block must be verified by the Trading Role that receives the Ping Request Block.

SIGNATURE BLOCK (PING REQUEST)

The Ping Request Signature Block (see section 8.16) contains the following components:

o one Signature Component (see section 7.19)

o one or more Certificate Components, if required.

PING RESPONSE BLOCK

The Ping Response Block (see section 8.15) contains the following component:

o the Organisation Component of the sender of the Ping Response

  message

If the Ping Transaction is not anonymous then the Ping Response additionally contains:

o copies of the Organisation Components contained in the Ping

  Request Block.

SIGNATURE BLOCK (PING RESPONSE)

The Ping Response Signature Block (see section 8.16) contains the following components:

o one Signature Component (see section 7.19)

o one or more Certificate Components, if required.

10. Retrieving Logos

This section describes how to retrieve logos for display by IOTP aware software using the Logo Net Locations attribute contained in the Brand Element (see section 7.7.1) and the Organisation Component (see section 7.6).

The full address of a logo is defined as follows: Logo_address ::= Logo_net_location "/" Logo_size Logo_color_depth ".gif"

Where:

o Logo_net_location is obtained from the LogoNetLocn attribute in

  the Brand Element (see section 7.7.1) or the Organisation
  Component. Note that:
  -  the content of this attribute is dependent on the Transport
     Mechanism (such as HTTP) that is used. See the Transport
     Mechanism supplement,
  -  implementers should check that if the rightmost character of
     Logo Net Location is set to right-slash "/" then another, right
     slash should not be included when generating the Logo Address,

o Logo_size identifies the size of the logo,

o Logo_color_depth identifies the colour depth of the logo

o "gif" indicates that the logos are in "gif" format

Logo_size and Logo_color_depth are specified by the implementer of the IOTP software that is retrieving the logo depending on the size and colour that they want to use.

10.1 Logo Size

There are five standard sizes for logos. The sizes in pixels and the corresponding values for Logo Size are given in the table below.

       Size in     Logo Size
       Pixels        Value
    32 x 32 or   exsmall
    32 x 20
    53 x 33      small
    103 x 65     medium
    180 x 114    large
    263 x 166    exlarge

10.2 Logo Color Depth

There are three standard colour depths. The colour depth (including bits per pixel) and the corresponding value for Logo_Color_Depth are given in the table below.

            Color Depth          Logo Color
         (bits per pixel)        Depth Value
     4 (16 colors)            4
     8 (256 colors)           nothing
     24 (16 million colors)   24

Note that if Logo Color Depth is omitted then a logo with the default colour depth of 256 colours will be retrieved.

10.3 Logo Net Location Examples

If Logo Net Location was set to "ftp://logos.xzpay.com", then:

o "ftp://logos.xzpay.com/medium.gif" would retrieve a medium size

  256 colour logo

o "http://logos.xzpay.com/small4.gif" would retrieve a small size 16

  colour logo

Note: Organisations which make logos available for use with IOTP should always make available "small" and "medium" size logos and use the "gif" format.

11. Brands

This section contains:

o a definition of Brands and an outline of Brand Selection using

  Brand Lists, and

o some XML examples of Brand Lists

11.1 Brand Definitions and Brand Selection

One of the key features of IOTP is the ability for a merchant to offer a list of Brands from which a consumer may make a selection. This section provides an overview of what is involved and provides guidance on how selection of a brand and associated payment instrument can be carried out by a Consumer. It covers:

o definitions of Payment Instruments and Brands - what are Payment

  Instruments and Brands in an IOTP context. Further categorises
  Brands as optionally a "Dual Brand" or a "Promotional Brand",

o identification and selection of Promotional Brands - Promotional

  Brands offer a Consumer some additional benefit, for example
  loyalty points or a discount. This means that both Consumers and
  Merchant must be able to correctly identify that a valid
  Promotional Brand is being used.

Also see the following sections:

o Brand List Component (section 7.7) which contains definitions of

  the XML elements which contain the list of Brands offered by a
  Merchant to a Consumer, and

o Brand Selection Component (section 7.8) for details of how a

  Consumer records the Brand, currency, amount and payment protocol
  that was selected.

11.1.1 Definition of Payment Instrument

A Payment Instrument is the means by which a Consumer pays for goods or services offered by a Merchant. It can be, for example:

o a credit card such as MasterCard or Visa;

o a debit card such as MasterCard's Maestro;

o a smart card based electronic cash payment instrument such as a

  Mondex Card, a GeldKarte card or a Visa Cash card

o a software based electronic payment account such as a CyberCash or

  DigiCash account.

Most Payment Instruments have a number, typically an account number, by which the Payment Instrument can be identified.

11.1.2 Definition of Brand

A Brand is the mark which identifies a particular type of Payment Instrument. A list of Brands are the payment options which are presented by the Merchant to the Consumer and from which the Consumer makes a selection. Each Brand may have a different Payment Handler. Examples of Brands include:

o payment association and proprietary Brands, for example

  MasterCard, Visa, American Express, Diners Club, Mondex,
  GeldKarte, CyberCash, etc.

o promotional brands (see below). These include:

  -  store brands, where the Payment Instrument is issued to a
     Consumer by a particular Merchant, for example Walmart, Sears,
     or Marks and Spencer (UK)
  -  cobrands, for example American Advantage Visa, where an
     Organisation uses their own brand in conjunction with,
     typically, a payment association Brand.

11.1.3 Definition of Dual Brand

A Dual Brand means that a single payment instrument may be used as if it were two separate Brands. For example there could be a single Japanese "UC" MasterCard which can be used as either a UC card or a regular MasterCard. The UC card Brand and the MasterCard Brand could each have their own separate Payment Handlers. This means that:

o the merchant treats, for example "UC" and "MasterCard" as two

  separate Brands when offering a list of Brands to the Consumer,

o the consumer chooses a Brand, for example either "UC" or

  "MasterCard,

o the consumer IOTP aware application determines which Payment

  Instrument(s) match the chosen Brand, and selects, perhaps with
  user assistance, the correct Payment Instrument to use.

Note: Dual Brands need no special treatment by the Merchant and therefore no explicit reference is made to Dual Brands in the DTD. This is because, as far as the Merchant is concerned, each Brand in a Dual Brand is treated as a separate Brand. It is at the Consumer, that the matching of a Brand to a Dual Brand Payment Instrument needs to be done.

11.1.4 Definition of Promotional Brand

A Promotional Brand means that, if the Consumer pays with that Brand, then the Consumer will receive some additional benefit which can be received in two ways:

o at the time of purchase. For example if a Consumer pays with a

  "Walmart MasterCard" at a Walmart web site, then a 5% discount
  might apply, which means the consumer actually pays less,

o from their Payment Instrument (card) issuer when the payment

  appears on their statement. For example loyalty points in a
  frequent flyer scheme could be awarded based on the total payments
  made with the Payment Instrument since the last statement was
  issued.

Note that:

o the first example (obtaining the benefit at the time of purchase),

  requires that:
  -  the Consumer is informed of the benefits which arise if that
     Brand is selected
  -  if the Brand is selected, the Merchant changes the relevant
     IOTP Components in the Offer Response to reflect the correct
     amount to be paid

o the second (obtaining a benefit through the Payment Instrument

  issuer) does not require that the Offer Response is changed

o each Promotional Brand should be identified as a separate Brand in

  the list of Brands offered by the Merchant. For example:
  "Walmart", "Sears", "Marks and Spencer" and "American Advantage
  Visa", would each be a separate Brand.

11.1.5 Identifying Promotional Brands

There are two problems which need to handled in identifying Promotional Brands:

o how does the Merchant or their Payment Handler positively identify

  the promotional brand being used at the time of purchase

o how does the Consumer reliably identify the correct promotional

  brand from the Brand List presented by the Merchant

The following is a description of how this could be achieved.

Note: Please note that the approach described here is a model approach that solves the problem. Other equivalent methods may be used.

11.1.5.1 Merchant/Payment Handler Identification of Promotional Brands

Correct identification that the Consumer is paying using a Promotional Brand is important since a Consumer might fraudulently claim to have a Promotional Brand that offers a reduced payment amount when in reality they do not.

Two approaches seem possible:

o use some feature of the Payment Instrument or the payment method

  to positively identify the Brand being used. For example, the SET
  certificate for the Brand could be used, if one is available, or

o use the Payment Instrument (card) number to look up information

  about the Payment Instrument on a Payment Instrument issuer
  database to determine if the Payment Instrument is a promotional
  brand.

Note that:

o the first assumes that SET is available.

o the second is only possible if the Merchant, or alternatively the

  Payment Handler, has access to card issuer information.

IOTP does not provide the Merchant with Payment Instrument information (e.g., a card or account number). This is only sent as part of the encapsulated payment protocol to a Payment Handler. This means that:

o the Merchant would have to assume that the Payment Instrument

  selected was a valid Promotional Brand, or

o the Payment Handler would have to check that the Payment

  Instrument was for the valid Promotional Brand and fail the
  payment if it was not.

A Payment Handler checking that a brand is a valid Promotional Brand is most likely if the Payment Handler is also the Card Issuer.

11.1.5.2 Consumer Selection of Promotional Brands

Two ways by which a Consumer can correctly select a Promotional Brand are:

o the Consumer visually matching a logo for the Promotional Brand

  which has been provided to the Consumer by the Merchant,

o the Consumer's IOTP aware application matching a code for the

  Promotional Brand which the application has registered against a
  similar code contained in the list of Brands offered by the
  Merchant.

In the latter case, the code contained in the Consumer wallet must match exactly the code in the list offered by the Merchant otherwise no match will be found. Ways in which the Consumer's IOTP Aware Application could obtain such a code include:

o the Consumer types the code in directly. This is error prone and

  not user friendly, also the consumer needs to be provided with the
  code.  This approach is not recommended,

o using one of the Brand Identifiers defined by IOTP and pre-loaded

  into the Consumers IOTP Aware application or wallet by the
  developer of the Wallet,

o using some information contained in the software or other data

  associated with the Payment Instrument. This could be:
  -  a SET certificate for Brands which use this payment method
  -  a code provided by the payment software which handles the
     particular payment method, this could apply to, for example,
     GeldKarte, Mondex, CyberCash and DigiCash,

o the consumer making an initial "manual" link between a Promotional

  Brand in the list of Brands offered by the Merchant and an
  individual Payment Instrument, the first time the promotional
  brand is used. The IOTP Aware application would then "remember"
  the code for the Promotional Brand for use in future purchases.

11.1.5.3 Consumer Software Brand Id recommendation

New Brand Ids are allocated under IANA procedures (see section 12 IANA Considerations). Which also contains an initial list of Brand Identifiers.

It is recommended that implementers of consumer IOTP aware applications (e.g., software wallets) pre-load their software with the then current set of Brand Ids and provide a method by which they can be updated. For example, by going to the software developer's web site.

11.2 Brand List Examples

This example contains three examples of the XML for a Brand List Component. It covers:

o a simple credit card based example

o a credit card based brand list including promotional credit card

  brands, and

o a complex electronic cash based brand list

Note that:

o brand lists can be as complex or as simple as required

o all example techniques described in this appendix can be included

  in one brand list.

11.2.1 Simple Credit Card Based Example

This is a simple example involving:

o only major credit card payment brands

o a single price in a single currency

o a single Payment Handler, and

o a single payment protocol

<BrandList ID='M1.2'

 XML:Lang='us-en'
 ShortDesc='Purchase book including s&h'
 PayDirection='Debit' >
 <Brand ID ='M1.30'
   BrandId='MasterCard'
   BrandName='MasterCard Credit'
   BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp://otplogos.mastercard.com/mastercardcredit'
   ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.33'>
 </Brand>
 <Brand ID ='M.31'
   BrandId='Visa'
   BrandName='Visa Credit'
   BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp://otplogos.visa.com/visacredit'
   ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.33'>
 </Brand>
 <Brand ID ='M1.32'
   BrandId='AmericanExpress'
   BrandName='American Express'
   BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp://otplogos.amex.com'
   ProtocolAmountRefs ='M1.33' >
 </Brand >
 <ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.33'
   PayProtocolRef='M1.35'
   CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.34'>
 </ProtocolAmount>
 <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.34'
   Amount='10.95'
   CurrCode='USD'/>
 <PayProtocol ID ='M1.35'
   ProtocolId='SCCD1.0'
   ProtocolName='Secure Channel Credit/Debit'
   PayReqNetLocn='http://www.example.com/etill/sccd1' >
 </PayProtocol>

</BrandList>

11.2.2 Credit Card Brand List Including Promotional Brands

An example of a Credit Card based Brand List follows. It includes:

o two ordinary card association brands and two promotional credit

  card brands. The promotional brands consist of one loyalty based
  (British Airways MasterCard) which offers additional loyalty
  points and one store based (Walmart) which offers a discount on
  purchases over a certain amount

o two payment protocols:

  -  SET (Secure Electronic Transactions) see [SET], and
  -  SCCD (Secure Channel Credit Debit) see [SCCD].
<BrandList ID='M1.2'

XML:Lang='us-en' ShortDesc='Purchase ladies coat' PayDirection='Debit' > <Brand ID ='M1.3'

 BrandId='MasterCard'
 BrandName='MasterCard Credit'
 BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp://otplogos.mastercard.com'
 ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.7 M1.8'>
 <ProtocolBrand ProtocolId='SET1.0' ProtocolBrandId='MasterCard:'>
 </ProtocolBrand>

</Brand> <Brand ID ='M1.4'

 BrandId='Visa'
 BrandName='Visa Credit'
 BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp://otplogos.visa.com'
 ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.7 M1.8'>
 <ProtocolBrand ProtocolId='SET1.0' ProtocolBrandId='Visa:'>
 </ProtocolBrand>

</Brand> <Brand ID ='M1.5'

 BrandId='BritishAirwaysMC'
 BrandName='British Airways MasterCard'
 BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp://otplogos.britishairways.co.uk'
 BrandNarrative='Double air miles with British Airways MasterCard'
 ProtocolAmountRefs ='M1.7 M1.8' >
 <ProtocolBrand ProtocolId='SET1.0' ProtocolBrandId='MasterCard:BA'>
 </ProtocolBrand>

</Brand > <Brand ID ='M1.6'

 BrandId='Walmart'
 BrandName='Walmart Store Card'
 BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp://otplogos.walmart.com'
 BrandNarrative='5% off with your Walmart Card
               on purchases over $150'
 ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.8'>

</Brand> <ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.7'

 PayProtocolRef='M1.10'
 CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.9' >
 <PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
    238djqw1298erh18dhoire
 </PackagedContent>

</ProtocolAmount> <ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.8'

 PayProtocolRef='M1.11'
 CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.9' >
 <PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
    238djqw1298erh18dhoire
 </PackagedContent>

</ProtocolAmount> <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.9'

 Amount='157.53'
 CurrCode='USD'/>

<PayProtocol ID ='M1.10'

 ProtocolId='SET1.0'
 ProtocolName='Secure Electronic Transaction Version 1.0'
 PayReqNetLocn='http://www.example.com/etill/set1' >
 <PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
   8ueu26e482hd82he82
 </PackagedContent>

</PayProtocol> <PayProtocol ID ='M1.11'

 ProtocolId='SCCD1.0'
 ProtocolName='Secure Channel Credit/Debit'
 PayReqNetLocn='http://www.example.com/etill/sccd1' >
 <PackagedContent Transform="BASE64">
    82hd82he8226e48ueu
 </PackagedContent>

</PayProtocol>

 </BrandList>

11.2.3 Brand Selection Example

In order to pay by 'British Airways' MasterCard using the example above using SET and therefore getting double air miles, the Brand Selection would be:

<BrandSelection ID='C1.2'

 BrandListRef='M1.3'
 BrandRef='M1.5'
 ProtocolAmountRef='M1.7'
 CurrencyAmountRef='M1.9' >

</BrandSelection>

11.2.4 Complex Electronic Cash Based Brand List

The following is an fairly complex example which includes:

o payments using either Mondex, GeldKarte, CyberCash or DigiCash

o in currencies including US dollars, British Pounds, Italian Lira,

  German Marks and Canadian Dollars

o a discount on the price if the payment is made in Mondex using

  British pounds or US dollars, and

o more than one Payment Handler is used for payments involving

  Mondex or CyberCash

o support for more than one version of a CyberCash CyberCoin payment

  protocol.

<BrandList ID='M1.2'

 XML:Lang='us-en'
 ShortDesc='Company report on XYZ Co'
 PayDirection='Debit' >
 <Brand ID ='M1.13'
   BrandId='Mondex'
   BrandName='Mondex Electronic Cash'
   BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp://otplogos.mondex.com'
   ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.17 M1.18'>
 </Brand>
 <Brand ID ='M1.14'
   BrandId='GeldKarte'
   BrandName='GeldKarte Electronic Cash'
   BrandLogoNetLocn='ftp://otplogos.geldkarte.co.de'
   ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.19'>
 </Brand>
 <Brand ID ='M1.15'
   BrandId='CyberCoin'
   BrandName='CyberCoin Eletronic Cash'
   BrandLogoNetLocn='http://otplogos.cybercash.com'
   ProtocolAmountRefs ='M1.20' >
 </Brand >
 <Brand ID ='M1.16'
   BrandId='DigiCash'
   BrandName='DigiCash Electronic Cash'
   BrandLogoNetLocn='http://otplogos.digicash.com'
   BrandNarrative='5% off with your Walmart Card
                 on purchases over $150'
   ProtocolAmountRefs='M1.22'>
 </Brand>
 <ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.17'
   PayProtocolRef='M1.31'
   CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.25 M1.29'>
 </ProtocolAmount>
 <ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.18'
   PayProtocolRef='M1.32'
   CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.26 M1.27 M1.28 M1.30'>
 </ProtocolAmount>
 <ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.19'
   PayProtocolRef='M1.35'
   CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.28'>
 </ProtocolAmount>
 <ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.20'
   PayProtocolRef='M1.34 M1.33'
   CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.23 M1.24 M1.27 M1.28 M1.29 M1.30'>
 </ProtocolAmount>
 <ProtocolAmount ID ='M1.21'
   PayProtocolRef='M1.36'
   CurrencyAmountRefs='M1.23 M1.24 M1.27 M1.28 M1.29 M1.30'>
 </ProtocolAmount>
 <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.23'
   Amount='20.00'
   CurrCode='USD'/>
 <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.24'
   Amount='12.00'
   CurrCode='GBP'/>
 <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.25'
   Amount='19.50'
   CurrCode='USD'/>
 <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.26'
   Amount='11.75'
   CurrCode='GBP'/>
 <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.27'
   Amount='36.00'
   CurrCode='DEM'/>
 <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.28'
   Amount='100.00'
   CurrCode='FFR'/>
 <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.29'
   Amount='22.00'
   CurrCode='CAD'/>
 <CurrencyAmount ID ='M1.30'
   Amount='15000'
   CurrCode='ITL'/>
 <PayProtocol ID ='M1.31'
   ProtocolId='MXv1.0'
   ProtocolName='Mondex IOTP Protocol Version 1.0'
   PayReqNetLocn='http://www.mxbankus.com/etill/mx' >
 </PayProtocol>
 <PayProtocol ID ='M1.32'
   ProtocolId='MXv1.0'
   ProtocolName='Mondex IOTP Protocol Version 1.0'
   PayReqNetLocn='http://www.mxbankuk.com/vserver' >
 </PayProtocol>
 <PayProtocol ID ='M1.33'
   ProtocolId='Ccashv1.0'
   ProtocolName='CyberCoin Version 1.0'
   PayReqNetLocn='http://www.cybercash.com/ccoin' >
 </PayProtocol>
 <PayProtocol ID ='M1.34'
   ProtocolId='CCashv2.0'
   ProtocolName='CyberCoin Version 2.0'
   PayReqNetLocn='http://www.cybercash.com/ccoin' >
 </PayProtocol>
 <PayProtocol ID ='M1.35'
   ProtocolId='GKv1.0'
   ProtocolName='GeldKarte Version 1.0'
   PayReqNetLocn='http://www.example.com/pgway' >
 </PayProtocol>
 <PayProtocol ID ='M1.36'
   ProtocolId='DCashv1.0'
   ProtocolName='DigiCash Protocol Version 1.0'
   PayReqNetLocn='http://www.example.com/digicash' >
 </PayProtocol>
 </BrandList>

12. IANA Considerations

This section describes the codes that are controlled by IANA, and also how new codes can be created for testing purposes that are not controlled by IANA.

12.1 Codes Controlled by IANA

To help ensure interoperability, there is a need for codes used by IOTP to be maintained in a controlled environment so that their meaning and usage are well defined and duplicate codes avoided. [IANA] is the mechanism to be used for this purpose as described in RFC 2434.

The element types and attributes names to which this procedure applies is shown in the table below together with the initial values that are valid for these attributes.

Note that:

o the IETF Trade mailing list's email address is ietf-

  [email protected]

o "Designated Experts" (see [IANA]) are appointed by the IESG.

 Element Type/                     Attribute Values
 Attribute Name

Algorithm/ "sha1" - indicates that a [SHA1] authentication Name will apply (When Algorithm is a child of an "signature" - indicates that authentication AuthReq consists of the generation of a digital signature. Component)

                  "Pay:ppp" where "ppp" may be set to any valid
                  value for "iotpbrand" (see below)
                  With the exception of Algorithms that begin with
                  "pay:", new values are allocated following review
                  on the IETF Trade mailing list and by the
                  Designated Expert.

Note: The Algorithm element is likely to be eventually defined within the [DSIG] name space. It is likely that the maintenance procedure defined here may need to vary over time, as the DSIG proposals become more widely adopted.

 Element Type/                     Attribute Values
 Attribute Name

Brand/BrandId The following list of initial BrandIds have been

                  taken from those Organisations that have applied
                  for SET certificates as at 1st June 1999:
                  "Amex" - American Express
                  "Dankort" - Dankort
                  "JCB" - JCB
                  "Maestro" - Maestro
                  "MasterCard" - MasterCard
                  "NICOS" - NICOS
                  "VISA" - Visa
                  In addition the following Brand Id values are
                  defined:
                  "Mondex"
                  "GeldKarte"
                  New values of BrandId must be announced to the
                  IETF Trade mailing list and, if there are no
                  objections within three weeks, are allocated on a
                  "first come first served" basis.

CurrencyAmount/ Currency codes are dependent on CurrCodeType (see CurrCode below).

                  If CurrCodeType is "ISO4217-A" then the currency
                  code is an alphabetic currency code as defined by
                  [ISO4217].
                  If CurrCodeType is "IOTP" then new values must be
                  announced to the IETF Trade mailing list and, if
                  there are no objections within three weeks, are
                  allocated on a "first come first served" basis.

Note: The Currency Code Type of IOTP, is designed to allow the support of "new" psuedo currencies such as loyalty or frequent flyer points. At the time of writing this specification, no currency codes of this type have been defined.

 Element Type/                     Attribute Values
 Attribute Name

CurrencyAmount/ "ISO4217-A" CurrCodeType

                  "IOTP"
                  New values of CurrCodeType attribute are allocated
                  following review on the IETF Trade mailing list
                  and by the Designated Expert.

DeliveryData/ "Post" DelivMethod

                  "Web"
                  "Email"
                  New values of Delivery Method attribute are
                  allocated following review on the IETF Trade
                  mailing list and by the Designated Expert. This
                  may require the publication of additional
                  documentation to describe how the delivery method
                  is used.

PackagedContent/ "PCDATA" Content

                  "MIME"
                  "MIME:mimetype" (where mimetype must be the same
                  as content-type as defined by [MIME] )
                  "XML"
                  If the Content attribute is of the form
                  "MIME"mimetype", then control of new values for
                  "mimetype" is as defined in [MIME].
                  Otherwise, new values of the Content attribute are
                  allocated following review on the IETF Trade
                  mailing list and by the Designated Expert. This
                  may require the publication of additional
                  documentation to describe how the new attribute is
                  used within a Packaged Content element.

RelatedTo/ "IotpTransaction" RelationshipType

                  "Reference"
                  New values of the RelationshipType attribute are
                  allocated following review on the IETF Trade
                  Working Group mailing list and by the Designated
                  Expert. This may require the publication of
                  additional documentation to describe how the
 Element Type/                     Attribute Values
 Attribute Name
                  delivery method is used.

Status/ Offer StatusType

                  Payment
                  Delivery
                  Authentication
                  Unidentified
                  New values of the Status Type attribute are
                  allocated following:
                   o publication to the IETF Trade Working Group,
                     of an RFC describing the Trading Exchange,
                     Trading Roles and associated components that
                     relate to the Status, and
                   o review of the document on the IETF Trade
                     mailing list and by the Designated Expert.

Note: The document describing new values for the Status Type attribute may be combined with documents that describe new Trading Roles and types of signatures (see below).

TradingRole/ "Consumer" TradingRole

                  "Merchant"
                  "PaymentHandler"
                  "DeliveryHandler"
                  "DelivTo"
                  "CustCare"
                  New values of the Trading Role attribute are
                  allocated following:
                   o publication to the IETF Trade Working Group,
                     of an RFC describing the Trading Exchange,
                     Trading Roles and associated components that
                     relate to the Trading Role, and
                   o review of the document on the IETF Trade
                     mailing list and by the Designated Expert.

Note: The document describing new values for the Trading Role attribute may be

 Element Type/                     Attribute Values
 Attribute Name
                               combined with documents that describe
                               new Status Types (see above) and
                               types of signatures (see below).

TransId/ "BaselineAuthentication" IotpTransType

                  "BaselineDeposit"
                  "BaselinePurchase"
                  "BaselineRefund"
                  "BaselineWithdrawal"
                  "BaselineValueExchange"
                  "BaselineInquiry"
                  "BaselinePing"
                  New values of the IotpTransType attribute are
                  allocated following:
                   o publication to the IETF Trade mailing list, of
                     an RFC describing the new IOTP Transaction, and
                   o review of the document on the IETF Trade
                     Working Group mailing list and by the
                     Designated Expert.

Attribute/ Content (see Signature

                  "OfferResponse"

Component) "PaymentResponse"

                  "DeliveryResponse"
                  "AuthenticationRequest"
                  "AuthenticationResponse"
                  "PingRequest"
                  "PingResponse"
                  New values of the code that define the type of a
                  signature are allocated following:
                   o publication to the IETF Trade Working Group,
                     of an RFC describing the Trading Exchange where
                     the signature is being used, and
                   o review of the document on the IETF Trade
                     mailing list and by the Designated Expert.
 Element Type/                     Attribute Values
 Attribute Name

Note: The document describing new values for the types of signatures may be combined with documents that describe new Status Types and Trading Roles (see above).

12.2 Codes not controlled by IANA

In addition to the formal development and registration of codes as described above, there is still a need for developers to experiment using new IOTP codes. For this reason, "user defined codes" may be used to identify additional values for the codes contained within this specification without the need for them to be registered with IANA.

The definition of a user defined code is as follows:

user_defined_code ::= ( "x-" | "X-" ) NameChar (NameChar)*

 NameChar           NameChar has the same definition as the [XML]
                    definition of NameChar

Use of domain names (see [DNS]) to make user defined codes unique is recommended although this method cannot be relied upon.

13. Internet Open Trading Protocol Data Type Definition

This section contains the XML DTD for the Internet Open Trading Protocols.


<!ELEMENT IotpMessage

  ( TransRefBlk,
    IotpSignatures?,
    ErrorBlk?,
    ( AuthReqBlk |
      AuthRespBlk |
      AuthStatusBlk |
      CancelBlk |
      DeliveryReqBlk |
      DeliveryRespBlk |
      InquiryReqBlk |
      InquiryRespBlk |
      OfferRespBlk |
      PayExchBlk |
      PayReqBlk |
      PayRespBlk |
      PingReqBlk |
      PingRespBlk |
      TpoBlk |
      TpoSelectionBlk
    )*
  ) >

<!ATTLIST IotpMessage

 xmlns              CDATA
  'iotp:ietf.org/iotp-v1.0' >


<!ELEMENT TransRefBlk (TransId, MsgId, RelatedTo*) > <!ATTLIST TransRefBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT TransId EMPTY > <!ATTLIST TransId

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
Version            NMTOKEN #FIXED '1.0'
IotpTransId        CDATA   #REQUIRED
IotpTransType      CDATA   #REQUIRED
TransTimeStamp     CDATA   #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT MsgId EMPTY > <!ATTLIST MsgId

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
RespIotpMsg        NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
LangPrefList       NMTOKENS #IMPLIED
CharSetPrefList    NMTOKENS #IMPLIED
SenderTradingRoleRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
SoftwareId         CDATA   #REQUIRED
TimeStamp          CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT RelatedTo (PackagedContent) > <!ATTLIST RelatedTo

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
RelationshipType   NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
Relation           CDATA   #REQUIRED
RelnKeyWords       NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >


<!ELEMENT PackagedContent (#PCDATA) > <!ATTLIST PackagedContent

Name             CDATA     #IMPLIED
Content          NMTOKEN   "PCDATA"
Transform (NONE|BASE64)    "NONE" >

<!ELEMENT ProtocolOptions EMPTY > <!ATTLIST ProtocolOptions

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ShortDesc          CDATA   #REQUIRED
SenderNetLocn      CDATA   #IMPLIED
SecureSenderNetLocn CDATA  #IMPLIED
SuccessNetLocn     CDATA   #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT AuthReq (Algorithm, PackagedContent*)> <!ATTLIST AuthReq

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
AuthenticationId   CDATA   #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT AuthResp (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST AuthResp

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
AuthenticationId   CDATA   #REQUIRED
SelectedAlgorithmRef NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT TradingRoleInfoReq EMPTY> <!ATTLIST TradingRoleInfoReq

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
TradingRoleList    NMTOKENS #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT Order (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST Order

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OrderIdentifier    CDATA   #REQUIRED
ShortDesc          CDATA   #REQUIRED
OkFrom             CDATA   #REQUIRED
OkTo               CDATA   #REQUIRED
ApplicableLaw      CDATA   #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT Org (TradingRole+, ContactInfo?,

    PersonName?, PostalAddress?)>

<!ATTLIST Org

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
OrgId              CDATA   #REQUIRED
LegalName          CDATA   #IMPLIED
ShortDesc          CDATA   #IMPLIED
LogoNetLocn        CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT TradingRole EMPTY > <!ATTLIST TradingRole

ID      ID#REQUIRED
TradingRole        NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
IotpMsgIdPrefix    NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
CancelNetLocn      CDATA   #IMPLIED
ErrorNetLocn       CDATA   #IMPLIED
ErrorLogNetLocn  CDATA           #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT ContactInfo EMPTY > <!ATTLIST ContactInfo

xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Tel                CDATA   #IMPLIED
Fax                CDATA   #IMPLIED
Email              CDATA   #IMPLIED
NetLocn            CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT PersonName EMPTY > <!ATTLIST PersonName

xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
Title              CDATA   #IMPLIED
GivenName          CDATA   #IMPLIED
Initials           CDATA   #IMPLIED
FamilyName         CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT PostalAddress EMPTY > <!ATTLIST PostalAddress

xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AddressLine1       CDATA   #IMPLIED
AddressLine2       CDATA   #IMPLIED
CityOrTown         CDATA   #IMPLIED
StateOrRegion      CDATA   #IMPLIED
PostalCode         CDATA   #IMPLIED
Country            CDATA   #IMPLIED
LegalLocation (True | False) 'False' >

<!ELEMENT BrandList (Brand+, ProtocolAmount+,

CurrencyAmount+, PayProtocol+) >

<!ATTLIST BrandList

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ShortDesc          CDATA   #REQUIRED
PayDirection (Debit | Credit) #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT Brand (ProtocolBrand*, PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST Brand

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
BrandId            CDATA   #REQUIRED
BrandName          CDATA   #REQUIRED
BrandLogoNetLocn   CDATA   #REQUIRED
BrandNarrative     CDATA   #IMPLIED
ProtocolAmountRefs IDREFS  #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT ProtocolBrand (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST ProtocolBrand

ProtocolId         CDATA   #REQUIRED
ProtocolBrandId    CDATA   #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT ProtocolAmount (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST ProtocolAmount

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
PayProtocolRef     IDREF   #REQUIRED
CurrencyAmountRefs IDREFS  #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT CurrencyAmount EMPTY > <!ATTLIST CurrencyAmount

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
Amount             CDATA   #REQUIRED
CurrCodeType       NMTOKEN 'ISO4217-A'
CurrCode           CDATA   #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT PayProtocol (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST PayProtocol

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProtocolId         NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProtocolName       CDATA   #REQUIRED
ActionOrgRef       NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
PayReqNetLocn      CDATA   #IMPLIED
SecPayReqNetLocn   CDATA   #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT BrandSelection (BrandSelBrandInfo?,

    BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo?,
    BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo?) >

<!ATTLIST BrandSelection

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
BrandListRef       NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
BrandRef           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ProtocolAmountRef  NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
CurrencyAmountRef  NMTOKEN #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT BrandSelBrandInfo (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST BrandSelBrandInfo

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST BrandSelProtocolAmountInfo

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST BrandSelCurrencyAmountInfo

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT Payment EMPTY > <!ATTLIST Payment

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
OkFrom             CDATA   #REQUIRED
OkTo               CDATA   #REQUIRED
BrandListRef       NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
SignedPayReceipt (True | False) #REQUIRED
StartAfterRefs     NMTOKENS #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT PaySchemeData (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST PaySchemeData

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
PaymentRef         NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ConsumerPaymentId  CDATA   #IMPLIED
PaymentHandlerPayId CDATA  #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT PayReceipt (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST PayReceipt

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
PaymentRef         NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
PayReceiptNameRefs NMTOKENS #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT PaymentNote (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST PaymentNote

 ID                ID      #REQUIRED
 ContentSoftwareId CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT Delivery (DeliveryData?, PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST Delivery

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivExch          (True | False) #REQUIRED
DelivAndPayResp    (True | False) #REQUIRED
ActionOrgRef       NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT DeliveryData (PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST DeliveryData

xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
OkFrom             CDATA   #REQUIRED
OkTo               CDATA   #REQUIRED
DelivMethod        NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivToRef         NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivReqNetLocn    CDATA   #IMPLIED
SecDelivReqNetLocn CDATA   #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT ConsumerDeliveryData EMPTY > <!ATTLIST ConsumerDeliveryData

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
ConsumerDeliveryId CDATA   #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT DeliveryNote (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST DeliveryNote

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
DelivHandlerDelivId CDATA  #IMPLIED
ContentSoftwareId  CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT Status EMPTY > <!ATTLIST Status

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
StatusType         NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ElRef              NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessState (NotYetStarted | InProgress |
    CompletedOk | Failed | ProcessError) #REQUIRED
CompletionCode     NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessReference   CDATA   #IMPLIED
StatusDesc         CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT TradingRoleData (PackagedContent+) > <!ATTLIST TradingRoleData

 ID                ID      #REQUIRED
 OriginatorElRef   NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
 DestinationElRefs NMTOKENS #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT InquiryType EMPTY > <!ATTLIST InquiryType

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
Type               NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ElRef              NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ProcessReference   CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT ErrorComp (ErrorLocation+, PackagedContent*) > <!ATTLIST ErrorComp

ID                 NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ErrorCode          NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
ErrorDesc          CDATA   #REQUIRED
Severity (Warning|TransientError|HardError) #REQUIRED
MinRetrySecs       CDATA   #IMPLIED
SwVendorErrorRef   CDATA   #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT ErrorLocation EMPTY > <!ATTLIST ErrorLocation

ElementType        NMTOKEN #REQUIRED
IotpMsgRef         NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
BlkRef             NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
CompRef            NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
ElementRef         NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
AttName            NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >


<!ELEMENT TpoBlk ( ProtocolOptions, BrandList*, Org* ) > <!ATTLIST TpoBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT TpoSelectionBlk (BrandSelection+) > <!ATTLIST TpoSelectionBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT OfferRespBlk (Status, Order?, Payment*,

            Delivery?, TradingRoleData*) >

<!ATTLIST OfferRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT AuthReqBlk (AuthReq*, TradingRoleInfoReq?) > <!ATTLIST AuthReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT AuthRespBlk (AuthResp?, Org*) > <!ATTLIST AuthRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT AuthStatusBlk (Status) > <!ATTLIST AuthStatusBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT PayReqBlk (Status+, BrandList, BrandSelection,

    Payment, PaySchemeData?, Org*, TradingRoleData*) >

<!ATTLIST PayReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT PayExchBlk (PaySchemeData) > <!ATTLIST PayExchBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT PayRespBlk (Status, PayReceipt?, PaySchemeData?,

    PaymentNote?, TradingRoleData*) >

<!ATTLIST PayRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT DeliveryReqBlk (Status+, Order, Org*, Delivery,

    ConsumerDeliveryData?, TradingRoleData*) >

<!ATTLIST DeliveryReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT DeliveryRespBlk (Status, DeliveryNote) > <!ATTLIST DeliveryRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT InquiryReqBlk ( InquiryType, PaySchemeData? ) > <!ATTLIST InquiryReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT InquiryRespBlk (Status, PaySchemeData?) > <!ATTLIST InquiryRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
LastReceivedIotpMsgRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
LastSentIotpMsgRef NMTOKEN #IMPLIED >

<!ELEMENT PingReqBlk (Org*)> <!ATTLIST PingReqBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED>

<!ELEMENT PingRespBlk (Org+)> <!ATTLIST PingRespBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED
PingStatusCode (Ok | Busy | Down) #REQUIRED
SigVerifyStatusCode (Ok | NotSupported | Fail) #IMPLIED
xml:lang           NMTOKEN #IMPLIED
PingStatusDesc     CDATA   #IMPLIED>

<!ELEMENT ErrorBlk (ErrorComp+, PaySchemeData*) > <!ATTLIST ErrorBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >

<!ELEMENT CancelBlk (Status) > <!ATTLIST CancelBlk

ID                 ID      #REQUIRED >


<!ELEMENT IotpSignatures (Signature+ ,Certificate*) > <!ATTLIST IotpSignatures

   ID        ID        #IMPLIED

>


<!ELEMENT Signature (Manifest, Value+) > <!ATTLIST Signature

   ID         ID        #IMPLIED

>

<!ELEMENT Manifest

   (       Algorithm+,
           Digest+,
           Attribute*,
           OriginatorInfo,
           RecipientInfo+
   )

>

<!ATTLIST Manifest

   LocatorHRefBase       CDATA             #IMPLIED

>

<!ELEMENT Algorithm (Parameter*) > <!ATTLIST Algorithm

   ID                     ID                #REQUIRED
   type            (digest|signature)      #IMPLIED
   name                  NMTOKEN           #REQUIRED

>

<!ELEMENT Digest (Locator, Value) > <!ATTLIST Digest

   DigestAlgorithmRef    IDREF             #REQUIRED

>

<!ELEMENT Attribute ( ANY ) > <!ATTLIST Attribute

   type                   NMTOKEN           #REQUIRED
   critical            ( true | false )     #REQUIRED

>

<!ELEMENT OriginatorInfo ANY >

<!ATTLIST OriginatorInfo

   OriginatorRef           NMTOKEN          #IMPLIED

>

<!ELEMENT RecipientInfo ANY > <!ATTLIST RecipientInfo

   SignatureAlgorithmRef   IDREF            #REQUIRED
   SignatureValueRef       IDREF            #IMPLIED
   SignatureCertRef        IDREF            #IMPLIED
   RecipientRefs           NMTOKENS         #IMPLIED

>

<!ELEMENT KeyIdentifier EMPTY> <!ATTLIST KeyIdentifier

   value                    CDATA           #REQUIRED

>

<!ELEMENT Parameter ANY > <!ATTLIST Parameter

   type                     CDATA           #REQUIRED

>


<!ELEMENT Certificate

(  IssuerAndSerialNumber,  ( Value | Locator ) )

>

<!ATTLIST Certificate

   ID                        ID                #IMPLIED
   type                      NMTOKEN           #REQUIRED

>

<!ELEMENT IssuerAndSerialNumber EMPTY > <!ATTLIST IssuerAndSerialNumber

   issuer                     CDATA            #REQUIRED
   number                     CDATA            #REQUIRED

>

<!ELEMENT Value ( #PCDATA ) > <!ATTLIST Value

   ID               ID           #IMPLIED
   encoding    (base64|none)    'base64'

>

<!ELEMENT Locator EMPTY> <!ATTLIST Locator

   xml:link        CDATA         #FIXED        'simple'
   href            CDATA         #REQUIRED

>

14. Glossary

This section contains a glossary of some of the terms used within this specification in alphabetical order.

      NAME                            DESCRIPTION

Authenticator The Organisation which is requesting the

                  authentication of another Organisation, and

Authenticatee The Organisation being authenticated by an

                  Authenticator

Business Error See Status Component.

Brand A Brand is the mark which identifies a particular

                  type of Payment Instrument. A list of Brands are
                  the payment options which are presented by the
                  Merchant to the Consumer and from which the
                  Consumer makes a selection. Each Brand may have a
                  different Payment Handler. Examples of Brands
                  include:
                   o payment association and proprietary Brands,
                     for example MasterCard, Visa, American Express,
                     Diners Club, American Express, Mondex,
                     GeldKarte, CyberCash, etc.
                   o Promotional Brands (see below). These include:
                   o store Brands, where the Payment Instrument is
                     issued to a Consumer by a particular Merchant,
                     for example Walmart, Sears, or Marks and
                     Spencer (UK)
                   o coBrands, for example American Advantage Visa,
                     where an a company uses their own Brand in
                     conjunction with, typically, a payment
                     association Brand.

Consumer The Organisation which is to receive the benefit

                  of and typically pay for the goods or services.

ContentSoftwareId This contains information which identifies the

                  software which generated the content of the
                  element. Its purpose is to help resolve
                  interoperability problems that might occur as a
                  result of incompatibilities between messages
                  produced by different software. It is a single
                  text string in the language defined by xml:lang.
                  It must contain, as a minimum:
                   o the name of the software manufacturer
                   o the name of the software
                   o the version of the software, and
                   o the build of the software
                  It is recommended that this attribute is included
                  whenever the software which generated the content
                  cannot be identified from the SoftwareId attribute
                  on the Message Id Component (see section 3.3.2)

Customer Care An Organisation that is providing customer care Provider typically on behalf of a Merchant. Examples of

                  customer care include, responding to problems
                  raised by a Consumer arising from an IOTP
                  Transaction that the Consumer took part in.

Delivery Handler The Organisation that directly delivers the goods

                  or services to the Consumer on behalf of the
                  Merchant. Delivery can be in the form of either
                  digital goods (e.g., a [MIME] message), or
                  physically delivered using the post or a courier.

Document Exchange A Document Exchange consists of a set of IOTP

                  Messages exchanged between two parties that
                  implement part or all of two Trading Exchanges
                  simultaneously in order to minimise the number of
                  actual IOTP Messages which must be sent over the
                  Internet.
                  Document Exchanges are combined together in
                  sequence to implement a particular IOTP
                  Transaction.

Dual Brand A Dual Brand means that a single Payment

                  Instrument may be used as if it were two separate
                  Brands. For example there could be a single
                  Japanese "UC" MasterCard which can be used as
                  either a UC card or a regular MasterCard. The UC
                  card Brand and the MasterCard Brand could each
                  have their own separate Payment Handlers. This
                  means that:
                   o the Merchant treats, for example "UC" and
                     "MasterCard" as two separate Brands when
                     offering a list of Brands to the Consumer,
                   o the Consumer chooses a Brand, for example
                     either "UC" or "MasterCard,
                   o the Consumer IOTP aware application determines
                     which Payment Instrument(s) match the chosen
                     Brand, and selects, perhaps with user
                     assistance, the correct Payment Instrument to
                     use.

Error Block An Error Block reports that a Technical Error was

                  found in an IOTP Message that was previously
                  received. Typically Technical Errors are caused by
                  errors in the XML which has been received or some
                  technical failure of the processing of the IOTP
                  Message. Frequently the generation or receipt of
                  an Error Block will result in failure of the IOTP
                  Transaction. They are distinct from Business
                  Errors, reported in a Status Component, which can
                  also cause failure of an IOTP Transaction.

Exchange Block An Exchange Block is sent between the two Trading

                  Roles involved in a Trading Exchange. It contains
                  one or more Trading Components. Exchange Blocks
                  are always sent after a Request Block and before a
                  Response Block in a Trading Exchange. The content
                  of an Exchange Block is dependent on the type of
                  Trading Exchange being carried out.

IOTP Message An IOTP Message is the outermost wrapper for the

                  document(s) which are sent between Trading Roles
                  that are taking part in a trade. It is a well
                  formed XML document. The documents it contains
                  consist of:
                   o a Transaction Reference Block to uniquely
                     identify the IOTP Transaction of which the IOTP
                     Message is part,
                   o an optional Signature Block to digitally sign
                     the Trading Blocks or Trading Components
                     associated with the IOTP Transaction
                   o an optional Error Block to report on technical
                     errors contained in a previously received IOTP
                     Message, and
                   o a collection of IOTP Trading Blocks which
                     carries the data required to carry out an IOTP
                     Transaction.

IOTP Transaction An instance of an Internet Open Trading Protocol

                  Transaction consists of a set of IOTP Messages
                  transferred between Trading Roles. The rules for
                  what may be contained in the IOTP Messages is
                  defined by the Transaction Type of the IOTP
                  Transaction.

IOTP Transaction A Transaction Type identifies the type an of IOTP Type Transaction. Examples of Transaction Type include:

                  Purchase, Refund, Authentication, Withdrawal,
                  Deposit (of electronic cash). The Transaction Type
                  specifies for an IOTP Transaction:
                   o the Trading Exchanges which may be included in
                     the transaction,
                   o how those Trading Exchanges may be combined to
                     meet the business needs of the transaction
                   o which Trading Blocks may be included in the
                     IOTP Messages that make up the transaction
                   o Consult this specification for the rules that
                     apply for each Transaction Type.

Merchant The Organisation from whom the service or goods

                  are being obtained, who is legally responsible for
                  providing the goods or services and receives the
                  benefit of any payment made

Merchant Customer The Organisation that is involved with customer Care Provider dispute negotiation and resolution on behalf of

                  the Merchant

Organisation A company or individual that takes part in a Trade

                  as a Trading Role. The Organisations may take one
                  or more of the roles involved in the Trade

Payment Handler The Organisation that physically receives the

                  payment from the Consumer on behalf of the
                  Merchant

Payment A Payment Instrument is the means by which Instrument Consumer pays for goods or services offered by a

                  Merchant. It can be, for example:
                   o a credit card such as MasterCard or Visa;
                   o a debit card such as MasterCard's Maestro;
                   o a smart card based electronic cash Payment
                     Instrument such as a Mondex Card, a GeldKarte
                     card or a Visa Cash card
                   o a software based electronic payment account
                     such as a CyberCash's CyberCoin or DigiCash
                     account.
                  All Payment Instruments have a number, typically
                  an account number, by which the Payment Instrument
                  can be identified.

Promotional Brand A Promotional Brand means that, if the Consumer

                  pays with that Brand, then the Consumer will
                  receive some additional benefit which can be
                  received in two ways:
                   o at the time of purchase. For example if a
                     Consumer pays with a "Walmart MasterCard" at a
                     Walmart web site, then a 5% discount might
                     apply, which means the Consumer actually pays
                     less,
                   o from their Payment Instrument (card) issuer
                     when the payment appears on their statement.
                     For example loyalty points in a frequent flyer
                     scheme could be awarded based on the total
                     payments made with the Payment Instrument since
                     the last statement was issued.
                  Each Promotional Brand should be identified as a
                  separate Brand in the list of Brands offered by
                  the Merchant.

Receipt Component A Receipt Component is a record of the successful

                  completion of a Trading Exchange. Examples of
                  Receipt Components include: Payment Receipts, and
                  Delivery Notes. It's content may dependent on the
                  technology used to perform the Trading Exchange.
                  For example a Secure Electronic Transaction (SET)
                  payment receipt consists of SET payment messages
                  which record the result of the payment.

Request Block A Request Block is Trading Block that contains a

                  request for a Trading Exchange to start. The
                  Trading Components in a Request Block may be
                  signed by a Signature Block so that their
                  authenticity may be checked and to determine that
                  the Trading Exchange being requested is
                  authorised. Authorisation for a Trading Exchange
                  to start can be provided by the signatures
                  contained on Receipt Components contained in
                  Response Blocks resulting from previously
                  completed Trading Exchanges.  Examples of Request
                  Blocks are Payment Request and Delivery Request

Response Block A Response Block is a Trading Block that indicates

                  that a Trading Exchange is complete. It is sent by
                  the Trading Role that received a Request Block to
                  the Trading Role that sent the Request Block. The
                  Response Block contains a Status Component that
                  contains information about the completion of the
                  Trading Exchange, for example it indicates whether
                  or not the Trading Exchange completed
                  successfully. For some Trading Exchanges the
                  Response Block contains a Receipt Component that
                  forms a record of the Trading Exchange. Receipt
                  Components may be digitally signed using a
                  Signature Block to make completion non-refutable.
                  Examples of Response Blocks include Offer
                  Response, Payment Response and Delivery Response.

Signature Block A Signature Block is a Trading Block that contains

                  one or more digital signatures in the form of
                  Signature Components. A Signature Component may
                  digitally sign any Block or Component in any IOTP
                  Message in the same IOTP Transaction.

Status Component A Status Component contains information that

                  describes the state of a Trading Exchange.
                  Before the Trading Exchange is complete the Status
                  Component can indicate information about how the
                  Trading Exchange is progressing.
                  Once a Trading Exchange is complete the Status
                  Component can only indicate the success of the
                  Trading Exchange or that a Business Error has
                  occurred.
                  A Business Error indicates that continuation with
                  the Trading Exchange was not possible because of
                  some business rule or logic, for example,
                  "insufficient funds available", rather than any
                  Technical Error associated with the content or
                  format of the IOTP Messages in the IOTP
                  Transaction.

Technical Error See Error Block.

Trading Block A Trading Block consists of one or more Trading

                  Components. One or more Trading Blocks may be
                  contained within the IOTP Messages which are
                  physically sent in the form of [XML] documents
                  between the different Trading Roles that are
                  taking part in a trade. Trading Blocks are of
                  three main types:
                   o a Request Block,
                   o an Exchange Block, or a
                   o a Response Block

Trading Component A Trading Component is a collection of XML

                  elements and attributes. Trading Components are
                  the child elements of the Trading Blocks. Examples
                  of Trading Components are: Offer, Brand List,
                  Payment Receipt, Delivery [information], Payment
                  Amount [information]

Trading Exchange A Trading Exchange consists of the exchange,

                  between two Trading Roles, of a sequence of
                  documents. The documents may be in the form of
                  Trading Blocks or they may be transferred by some
                  other means, for example through entering data
                  into a web page. Each Trading Exchange consists of
                  three main parts:
                   o the sending of a Request Block by one Trading
                     Role (the initiator) to another Trading Role
                     (the recipient),
                   o the optional exchange of one or more Exchange
                     Blocks between the recipient and the initiator,
                     until eventually,
                   o the Trading Role that received the Request
                     Block sends a Response Block to the initiator.
                  A Trading Exchange is designed to implement a
                  useful service of some kind. Examples of Trading
                  Exchanges/services are:
                   o Offer, which results in a Consumer receiving
                     an offer from a Merchant to carry out a
                     business transaction of some kind,
                   o Payment, where a Consumer makes a payment to a
                     Payment Handler,
                   o Delivery, where a Consumer requests, and
                     optionally obtains, delivery of goods or
                     services from a Delivery Handler, and
                   o Authentication, where any Trading Role may
                     request and receive information about another
                     Trading Role.

Trading Role A Trading Role identifies the different ways in

                  which Organisations can participate in a trade.
                  There are five Trading Roles: Consumer, Merchant,
                  Payment Handler, Delivery Handler, and Merchant
                  Customer Care Provider.

Transaction A Transaction Reference Block identifies an IOTP Reference Block Transaction. It contains data that identifies:

                   o the Transaction Type,
                   o the IOTP Transaction uniquely, through a
                     globally unique transaction identifier
                   o the IOTP Message uniquely within the IOTP
                     Transaction, through a message identifier
                  The Transaction Reference Block may also contain
                  references to other transactions which may or may
                  not be IOTP Transactions

15. References

This section contains references to related documents identified in this specification.

[Base64] Freed, N. and N. Borenstein, "Multipurpose Internet Mail

           Extensions (MIME) Part One: Format of Internet Message
           Bodies", RFC 2045, November 1996.

[DOM-HASH] Maruyama, H., Tamura, K. and N. Uramoto, "Digest Values

           for DOM (DOMHASH)", RFC 2803, April 2000.

[DNS] Mockapetris, P., "Domain names - concepts and

           facilities", STD 13, RFC 1034, November 1987.

[DNS] Mockapetris, P., "Domain names - implementation and

           specification", STD 13, RFC 1035, November 1987.

[DSA] The Digital Signature Algorithm (DSA) published by the

           National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST) in
           the Digital Signature Standard (DSS), which is a part of
           the US government's Capstone project.

[ECCDSA] Elliptic Curve Cryptosystems Digital Signature Algorithm

           (ECCDSA). Elliptic curve cryptosystems are analogues of
           public-key cryptosystems such as RSA in which modular
           multiplication is replaced by the elliptic curve addition
           operation. See: V. S. Miller. Use of elliptic curves in
           cryptography. In Advances in Cryptology - Crypto '85,
           pages 417-426, Springer-Verlag, 1986.

[HMAC] Krawczyk, H., Bellare, M. and R. Canetti, "HMAC: Keyed-

           Hashing for Message Authentication", RFC 2104, February
           1997.

[HTML] Berners-Lee, T. and D. Connolly, "Hypertext Markup

           Language - 2.0", RFC 1866, November 1995.

[HTML] Hyper Text Mark Up Language. The Hypertext Mark-up

           Language (HTML) is a simple mark-up language used to
           create hypertext documents that are platform independent.
           See the World Wide Web (W3C) consortium web site at:
           http://www.w3.org/MarkUp/

[HTTP] Berners-Lee, T., Fielding, R. and H. Frystyk, "Hypertext

           Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.0", RFC 1945, May 1996.

[HTTP] Fielding, R., Gettys, J., Mogul, J., Frystyk, T. and T.

           Berners-Lee, "Hypertext Transfer Protocol -- HTTP/1.1.",
           RFC 2616, June 1999.

[IANA] The Internet Assigned Numbers Authority. The organisation

           responsible for co-ordinating the names and numbers
           associated with the Internet. See http://www.iana.org/

[ISO4217] ISO 4217: Codes for the Representation of Currencies.

           Available from ANSI or ISO.

[IOTPDSIG] Davidson, K. and Y. Kawatsura, "Digital Signatures for

           the v1.0 Internet Open Trading Protocol (IOTP)", RFC
           2802, April 2000.

[MD5] Rivest, R., "The MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm", RFC 1321,

           April 1992.

[MIME] Crocker, D., "Standard for the Format of ARPA Internet

           Text Messages", STD 11, RFC 822, August 1982.

[MIME] Freed, N. and N. Borenstein, "Multipurpose Internet Mail

           Extensions (MIME) Part One: Format of Internet Message
           Bodies", RFC 2045, November 1996.

[MIME] Freed, N. and N. Borenstein, "Multipurpose Internet Mail

           Extensions (MIME) Part Two: Media Types", RFC 2046,
           November 1996.

[MIME] Moore, K., "MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions)

           Part Three: Message Header Extensions for Non-ASCII Text"
           RFC 2047, November 1996.

[MIME] Freed, N., Klensin, J. and J. Postel, "Multipurpose

           Internet Mail Extensions (MIME) Part Four: Registration
           Procedures", RFC 2048, November 1996.

[MIME] Freed, N. and N. Borenstein, "Multipurpose Internet Mail

           Extensions (MIME) Part Five: Conformance Criteria and
           Examples" RFC 2049, November 1996.

[OPS] Open Profiling Standard. A proposed standard which

           provides a framework with built-in privacy safeguards for
           the trusted exchange of profile information between
           individuals and web sites.  Being developed by Netscape
           and Microsoft amongst others.

RFC1738 Berners-Lee, T., Masinter, L. and M. McCahill, "Uniform

           Resource Locators (URL)", RFC 1738, December 1994.

RFC2434 Narten, T. and H. Alvestrand, "Guidelines for Writing an

           IANA Considerations Section in RFCs", BCP 26, RFC 2434,
           October 1998.

[RSA] RSA is a public-key cryptosystem for both encryption and

           authentication supported by RSA Data Security Inc. See:
           R. L. Rivest, A. Shamir, and L.M. Adleman. A method for
           obtaining digital signatures and public-key
           cryptosystems. Communications of the ACM, 21(2): 120-126,
           February 1978.

[SCCD] Secure Channel Credit Debit. A method of conducting a

           credit or debit card payment where unauthorised access to
           account information is prevented through use of secure
           channel transport mechanisms such as SSL/TLS. An IOTP
           supplement describing how SCCD works is under
           development.

[SET] Secure Electronic Transaction Specification, Version 1.0,

           May 31, 1997. Supports credit and debit card payments
           using certificates at the Consumer and Merchant to help
           ensure authenticity.  Download from:
           <http://www.setco.org>.

[SSL/TLS] Dierks, T. and C. Allen, "The TLS Protocol Version 1.0",

           RFC 2246, January 1999.

[SHA1] [FIPS-180-1]"Secure Hash Standard", National Institute of

           Standards and Technology, US Department Of Commerce,
           April 1995. Also known as: 59 Fed Reg. 35317 (1994). See
           http://www.itl.nist.gov/div897/pubs/fip180-1.htm

[UTC] Universal Time Co-ordinated. A method of defining time

           absolutely relative to Greenwich Mean Time (GMT).
           Typically of the form:  "CCYY-MM-DDTHH:MM:SS.sssZ+n"
           where the "+n" defines the number of hours from GMT. See
           ISO DIS8601.

[UTF16] The Unicode Standard, Version 2.0. The Unicode

           Consortium, Reading, Massachusetts. See ISO/IEC 10646 1
           Proposed Draft Amendment 1

[X.509] ITU Recommendation X.509 1993 | ISO/IEC 9594-8: 1995,

           Including Draft Amendment 1: Certificate Extensions
           (Version 3 Certificate)

[XML Recommendation for Namespaces in XML, World Wide Web Namespace] Consortium, 14 January 1999, "http://www.w3.org/TR/REC-

           xml-names"

[XML] Extensible Mark Up Language. A W3C recommendation. See

           http://www.w3.org/TR/1998/REC-xml-19980210 for the 10
           February 1998 version.

16. Author's Address

The author of this document is:

David Burdett Commerce One 4440 Rosewood Drive, Bldg 4 Pleasanton California 94588 USA

Phone: +1 (925) 520 4422 EMail: [email protected]

The author of this document particularly wants to thank Mondex International Limited (www.mondex.com) for the tremendous support provided in the formative stages of the development of this specification.

In addition the author appreciates the following contributors to this protocol (in alphabetic order of company) without which it could not have been developed.

  -  Phillip Mullarkey, British Telecom plc
  -  Andrew Marchewka, Canadian Imperial Bank of Commerce
  -  Brian Boesch, CyberCash Inc.
  -  Tom Arnold, CyberSource
  -  Terry Allen, Commerce One (formally Veo Systems)
  -  Richard Brown, GlobeSet Inc.
  -  Peter Chang, Hewlett Packard
  -  Masaaki Hiroya, Hitachi Ltd
  -  Yoshiaki Kawatsura, Hitachi Ltd
  -  Mark Linehan, International Business Machines
  -  Jonathan Sowler, JCP Computer Services Ltd
  -  John Wankmueller, MasterCard International
  -  Steve Fabes, Mondex International Ltd
  -  Donald Eastlake 3rd, Motorola Inc (formerly International
     Business Machines Inc)
  -  Surendra Reddy, Oracle Corporation
  -  Akihiro Nakano, Plat Home, Inc. (ex Hitachi Ltd)
  -  Chris Smith, Royal Bank of Canada
  -  Hans Bernhard-Beykirch, SIZ (IT Development and Coordination
     Centre of the German Savings Banks Organisation)
  -  W. Reid Carlisle, Spyrus (ex Citibank Universal Card Services,
     formally AT&T Universal Card Services)
  -  Efrem Lipkin, Sun Microsystems
  -  Tony Lewis, Visa International

The author would also like to thank the following organisations for their support:

  -  Amino Communications
  -  DigiCash
  -  Fujitsu
  -  General Information Systems
  -  Globe Id Software
  -  Hyperion
  -  InterTrader
  -  Nobil I T Corp
  -  Mercantec
  -  Netscape
  -  Nippon Telegraph and Telephone Corporation
  -  Oracle Corporation
  -  Smart Card Integrations Ltd.
  -  Spyrus
  -  Verifone
  -  Unisource nv
  -  Wells Fargo Bank

17. Full Copyright Statement

Copyright (C) The Internet Society (2000). All Rights Reserved.

This document and translations of it may be copied and furnished to others, and derivative works that comment on or otherwise explain it or assist in its implementation may be prepared, copied, published and distributed, in whole or in part, without restriction of any kind, provided that the above copyright notice and this paragraph are included on all such copies and derivative works. However, this document itself may not be modified in any way, such as by removing the copyright notice or references to the Internet Society or other Internet organizations, except as needed for the purpose of developing Internet standards in which case the procedures for copyrights defined in the Internet Standards process must be followed, or as required to translate it into languages other than English.

The limited permissions granted above are perpetual and will not be revoked by the Internet Society or its successors or assigns.

This document and the information contained herein is provided on an "AS IS" basis and THE INTERNET SOCIETY AND THE INTERNET ENGINEERING TASK FORCE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ANY WARRANTY THAT THE USE OF THE INFORMATION HEREIN WILL NOT INFRINGE ANY RIGHTS OR ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.

Acknowledgement

Funding for the RFC Editor function is currently provided by the Internet Society.